J-Link serial number config option
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * NAND Flash Commands:: NAND Flash Commands
77 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
78 * General Commands:: General Commands
79 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
80 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
81 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
82 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
83 * TFTP:: TFTP
84 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
85 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
86 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
87 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
88 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
89
90 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
91 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
92 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
93 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
94 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
95 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
96 @end menu
97
98 @node About
99 @unnumbered About
100 @cindex about
101
102 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
103 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
104 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
105 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
106 around the world.
107
108 @section What is OpenOCD?
109 @cindex TAP
110 @cindex JTAG
111
112 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
113 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
114 devices.
115
116 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
117 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
118 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
119 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
120 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
121 needed to hook up to the target.
122
123 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
124 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
125 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
126 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
127 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
128
129 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
130 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
131 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
132 let the development board connect directly to the debug
133 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
134
135 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
136 signaling, and is used to communicate
137 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
138 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
139 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
140 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
141 scan operations.
142
143 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
144 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
145 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
146 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
147
148 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
149 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
150 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
151 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
152
153
154 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
155 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
156 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
157
158 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
159 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
160 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
161 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
162
163 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
164 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
165 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
166 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
167 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
168
169 @section OpenOCD Web Site
170
171 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
172
173 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/}
174
175 @section Latest User's Guide:
176
177 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
178 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
179 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
180
181 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/html/index.html}
182
183 PDF form is likewise published at:
184
185 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
186
187 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
188
189 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
190 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
191 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
192 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
193 instead of this forum.
194
195 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
196
197 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
198
199 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
200 communication between users:
201
202 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
203
204 @section OpenOCD IRC
205
206 Support can also be found on irc:
207 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
208
209 @node Developers
210 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
211 @cindex developers
212
213 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
214 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
215 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
216 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
217
218 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
219 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
220
221 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
222
223 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
224 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
225
226 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
227
228 or via http
229
230 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
231
232 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
233
234 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
235
236 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
237 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
238 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
239 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
240 needing a Git client:
241
242 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
243
244 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
245 from the repository or a snapshot.
246
247 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
248 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
249 Patches created against older versions may require additional
250 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
251
252 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
253
254 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
255 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
256 technical information about the software internals, development
257 processes, and similar documentation:
258
259 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
260
261 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
262 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
263 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
264
265 @section Gerrit Review System
266
267 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
268 Code Review System:
269
270 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
271
272 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
273 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
274 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
275 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
276 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
277
278 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
279 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
280 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
281 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
282 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
283
284 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
285
286 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
287 communication between developers:
288
289 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
290
291 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
292
293 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
294
295 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/p/openocd/tickets/}
296
297
298 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
300 @cindex dongles
301 @cindex FTDI
302 @cindex wiggler
303 @cindex zy1000
304 @cindex printer port
305 @cindex USB Adapter
306 @cindex RTCK
307
308 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
309 an adapter .... [snip]
310
311 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
312 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
313 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
314 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
315 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
316 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
317 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
318
319
320 @section Choosing a Dongle
321
322 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
323
324 @enumerate
325 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
326 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
327 other ways to communicate with target devices.
328 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
329 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
330 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
331 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
332 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
333 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
334 Ethernet port needed?
335 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
336 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
337 @end enumerate
338
339 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
340
341 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
342 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
343 running on the developer's host computer.
344 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
345 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
346 IP address assigned to the probe.
347 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
348 OpenOCD debugger.
349 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
350 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
351 the target.
352 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
353 to power cycle the target remotely.
354
355 For more information, visit:
356
357 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
358
359 @section USB FT2232 Based
360
361 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
362 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
363 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
364 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
365 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
366 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
367 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
368 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
369 clocking.)
370
371 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
372 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
373 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
374 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
375 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
376
377 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
378 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
379
380 @itemize @bullet
381 @item @b{usbjtag}
382 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
383 @item @b{jtagkey}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
385 @item @b{jtagkey2}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
387 @item @b{oocdlink}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
389 @item @b{signalyzer}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
391 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
392 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
393 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
394 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
395 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
396 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
397 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
398 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
399 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
400 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
401 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
402 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
404 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
405 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
406 @item @b{turtelizer2}
407 @* See:
408 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
409 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
410 @item @b{comstick}
411 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
412 @item @b{stm32stick}
413 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
414 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
415 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
416 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
417 @item @b{cortino}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
419 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
421 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
422 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
423 @item @b{opendous}
424 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
425 (OpenHardware).
426 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
427 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
428
429 @item @b{GW16042}
430 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
431 FT2232H-based
432
433 @end itemize
434 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
435
436 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
437 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
438 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
439 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
440 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
441
442 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
443 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
444 (see the section on driver commands).
445
446 @itemize
447 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
448 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
449 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
450 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
451 @end itemize
452
453 @section USB JLINK based
454 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
455 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
456 AT91SAM764 internally.
457
458 @itemize @bullet
459 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
461 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
463 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
464 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
465 @end itemize
466
467 @section USB RLINK based
468 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
469 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
470 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
471
472 @itemize @bullet
473 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
477 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
478 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
479 @end itemize
480
481 @section USB ST-LINK based
482 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
483 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
484
485 @itemize @bullet
486 @item @b{ST-LINK}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
489 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
508 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
509 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
510
511 @section USB Other
512 @itemize @bullet
513 @item @b{USBprog}
514 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
515
516 @item @b{USB - Presto}
517 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
518
519 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
520 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
521
522 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
523 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
524
525 @item @b{Buspirate}
526 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
527
528 @item @b{opendous}
529 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
530
531 @item @b{estick}
532 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
533
534 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
536 @end itemize
537
538 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
539
540 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
541 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
542 these on the market.
543
544 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
545 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
546 of USB-based ones.
547
548 @itemize @bullet
549
550 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
551 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
552
553 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
554 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
555 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
556
557 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
558 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler2}
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
564 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
565
566 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
567 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
568
569 @item @b{arm-jtag}
570 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
571
572 @item @b{chameleon}
573 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
574
575 @item @b{Triton}
576 @* Unknown.
577
578 @item @b{Lattice}
579 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
580 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
581
582 @item @b{flashlink}
583 @* From ST Microsystems;
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
585
586 @end itemize
587
588 @section Other...
589 @itemize @bullet
590
591 @item @b{ep93xx}
592 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
593
594 @item @b{at91rm9200}
595 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
596
597 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
598 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
602 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
603
604 @end itemize
605
606 @node About Jim-Tcl
607 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex tcl
610
611 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
612 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
613 command interpreter.
614
615 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
616 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
617 much of anything about Tcl.
618 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
619
620 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
621 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
622 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
623 OpenOCD mailing list.
624
625 @itemize @bullet
626 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
627 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
628 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
629 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
630 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
631 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
632
633 @item @b{Missing Features}
634 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
635 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
636 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
637 enabled in OpenOCD.
638
639 @item @b{Scripts}
640 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
641 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
642 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
643
644 @item @b{Commands}
645 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
646 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
647 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
648 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
649
650 @item @b{Historical Note}
651 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
652 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
653 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
654 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
655
656 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
657 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
658 @end itemize
659
660 @node Running
661 @chapter Running
662 @cindex command line options
663 @cindex logfile
664 @cindex directory search
665
666 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
667 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
668 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
669 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
670 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
671 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
672 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
673
674 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
675 tell it how each debug session should work.
676 The @option{--help} option shows:
677 @verbatim
678 bash$ openocd --help
679
680 --help | -h display this help
681 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
682 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
683 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
684 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
685 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
686 --command | -c run <command>
687 @end verbatim
688
689 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
690 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
691 To specify one or more different
692 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
693
694 @example
695 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
696 @end example
697
698 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
699 @enumerate
700 @item the current directory,
701 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
702 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
703 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
704 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
705 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
706 @end enumerate
707 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
708
709 @quotation Note
710 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
711 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
712 @end quotation
713
714 @section Simple setup, no customization
715
716 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
717 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
718 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
719 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
720 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
721
722 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
723 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
724 the server with some variation of one of the following:
725
726 @example
727 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
729 @end example
730
731 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
732 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
733 If all goes well you'll see output something like
734
735 @example
736 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
737 For bug reports, read
738 http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
739 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
740 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
741 @end example
742
743 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
744 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
745 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
746
747 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
748
749 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
750 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
751 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
752 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
753 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
754 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
755 ensure that this always succeeds.
756 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
757 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
758 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
759 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
760
761 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
762 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
763 those channels.
764
765 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
766 the @option{-d} option.
767
768 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
769 @option{-c} command line switch.
770
771 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
772 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
773 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
774 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
775 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
776 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
777 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
778
779 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
780 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
781
782 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
783 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
784 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
785 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
786
787 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
788 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
789
790 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
791 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
792 and start the OpenOCD server.
793 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
794 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
795 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
796 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
797
798 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
799
800 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
801 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
802 and a USB cable on the other.
803 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
804 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
805
806 @enumerate
807 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
808 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
809 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
810 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
811 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
812 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
813 debugging host.
814
815 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
816 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
817 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
818 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
819 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
820
821 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
822 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
823 with 1.2 Volt boards.
824
825 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
826 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
827 ways to connect the cable.
828 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
829 Be sure it's firmly connected.
830
831 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
832 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
833 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
834 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
835 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
836 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
837 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
838 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
839
840 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
841 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
842 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
843 but are tedious to set up.
844 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
845 adapter signals to the right board pins.
846
847 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
848 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
849 you are using to run OpenOCD.
850 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
851
852 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
853 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
854 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
855 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
856
857 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
858 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
859 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
860
861 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
862 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
863 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
864 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
865
866 @end enumerate
867
868 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
869 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
870 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
871
872 @section Project Directory
873
874 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
875
876 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
877 single directory for your work with a given board.
878 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
879 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
880 files accessed through semihosting,
881 and for code you upload to the target board.
882 It is also the natural place to write files,
883 such as log files and data you download from the board.
884
885 @section Configuration Basics
886
887 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
888 a variety of ways you can mix them.
889 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
890
891 @itemize
892 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
893 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
894 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
895 @end itemize
896
897 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
898 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
899 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
900
901 @example
902 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
903
904 # GDB can also flash my flash!
905 gdb_memory_map enable
906 gdb_flash_program enable
907
908 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
909 @end example
910
911 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
912
913 @example
914 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
915 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
916 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
917 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
918 @end example
919
920 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
921 each supporting a different development task.
922 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
923 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
924
925 @quotation Important
926 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
927 problems with how it treats variables.
928 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
929 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
930 that can be tested in a later script.
931 @end quotation
932
933 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
934 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
935 to simplify your work.
936
937 @section User Config Files
938 @cindex config file, user
939 @cindex user config file
940 @cindex config file, overview
941
942 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
943 in one place.
944 One of the following will match your situation best:
945
946 @itemize
947 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
948 provided by someone else.
949 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
950 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
951 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
952 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
953 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
954 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
955
956 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
957 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
958
959 @enumerate
960 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
961 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
962 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
963 @end enumerate
964
965 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
966 The first is an interface config file.
967 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
968 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
969 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
970 meet your deadline:
971
972 @example
973 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
974 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
975 @end example
976
977 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
978 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
979 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
980 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
981
982 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
983 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
984 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
985 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
986 target and board
987 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
988 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
989
990 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
991 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
992 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
993 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
994
995 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
996 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
997 giving access to your particular flash chips.
998 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
999 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
1000
1001 @quotation Note
1002 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1003 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1004 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1005 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1006 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1007 @end quotation
1008
1009 @item
1010 You may may need to write some C code.
1011 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1012 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1013 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1014 a new chip architecture.
1015 @end itemize
1016
1017 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1018 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1019 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1020
1021 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1022 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1023 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1024 @itemize
1025
1026 @item
1027 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1028 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1029 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1030 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1031
1032 @item
1033 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1034 @cindex vector_catch
1035 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1036 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1037 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1038 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1039 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1040 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1041
1042 @item
1043 You might need to override some defaults.
1044 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1045 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1046
1047 @item
1048 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1049 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1050 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1051 @end itemize
1052
1053 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1054
1055 A few project-specific utility
1056 routines may well speed up your work.
1057 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1058
1059 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1060 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1061 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1062 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1063 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1064 may help:
1065
1066 @example
1067 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1068 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1069 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1070 # Leave the CPU halted.
1071 reset init
1072
1073 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1074 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1075
1076 # Start running.
1077 resume 0x20000000
1078 @}
1079 @end example
1080
1081 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1082 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1083 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1084 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1085 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1086
1087 @example
1088 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1089 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1090 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1091 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1092 reset init
1093
1094 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1095 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1096 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1097 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1098 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1099 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1101
1102 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1103 reset run
1104 @}
1105 @end example
1106
1107 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1108 from NAND.
1109 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1110 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1111 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1112
1113 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1114 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1115
1116 @section Target Software Changes
1117
1118 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1119 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1120 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1121 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1122 handling issues like:
1123
1124 @itemize @bullet
1125
1126 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1127 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1128 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1129 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1130 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1131 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1132 your debug sessions.
1133
1134 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1135 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1136 That might however be your only option.
1137
1138 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1139 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1140 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1141 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1142 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1143 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1144 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1145 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1146 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1147 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1148 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1149 instead of the whole thing.
1150 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1151 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1152
1153 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1154 @cindex ARM semihosting
1155 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1156 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1157 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1158 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1159 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1160 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1161 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1162 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1163 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1164 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1165 NAND or SPI flash.
1166
1167 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1168 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1169 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1170 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1171 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1172
1173 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1174 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1175 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1176 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1177 registers which can be used to change various features including
1178 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1179 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1180 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1181 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1182 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1183
1184 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1185 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1186 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1187 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1188 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1189
1190 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1191 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1192 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1193 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1194 early code execution can be debugged
1195 or firmware can be replaced.
1196
1197 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1198 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1199 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1200 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1201 operations like writing to memory.)
1202
1203 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1204 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1205 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1206 various kinds of message.
1207 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1208
1209 @end itemize
1210
1211 @section Target Hardware Setup
1212
1213 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1214 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1215 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1216 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1217 working with.}
1218
1219 Common issues include:
1220
1221 @itemize @bullet
1222
1223 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1224 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1225 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1226 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1227 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1228 or one from a daughtercard).
1229 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1230 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1231
1232 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1233 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1234 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1235 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1236 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1237 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1238
1239 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1240 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1241 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1242 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1243 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1244
1245
1246 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1247 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1248 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1249 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1250 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1251 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1252 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1253
1254 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1255 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1256 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1257 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1258 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1259
1260 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1261 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1262 used to start booting.
1263
1264 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1265 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1266 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1267 multiple audio codec chips).
1268 This interacts with software
1269 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1270 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1271 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1272 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1273 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1274 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1275 audio or video codecs are used.
1276
1277 @end itemize
1278
1279 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1280 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1281 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1282 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1283 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1284 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1285 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1286 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1287 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1288 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1289
1290
1291 @node Config File Guidelines
1292 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1293
1294 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1295 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1296 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1297 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1298
1299 You should find the following directories under @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts},
1300 with files including the ones listed here.
1301 Use them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1302 @itemize @bullet
1303 @item @file{interface} ...
1304 These are for debug adapters.
1305 Files that configure JTAG adapters go here.
1306 @example
1307 $ ls interface -R
1308 interface/:
1309 altera-usb-blaster.cfg hilscher_nxhx50_re.cfg openocd-usb-hs.cfg
1310 arm-jtag-ew.cfg hitex_str9-comstick.cfg openrd.cfg
1311 at91rm9200.cfg icebear.cfg osbdm.cfg
1312 axm0432.cfg jlink.cfg parport.cfg
1313 busblaster.cfg jtagkey2.cfg parport_dlc5.cfg
1314 buspirate.cfg jtagkey2p.cfg redbee-econotag.cfg
1315 calao-usb-a9260-c01.cfg jtagkey.cfg redbee-usb.cfg
1316 calao-usb-a9260-c02.cfg jtagkey-tiny.cfg rlink.cfg
1317 calao-usb-a9260.cfg jtag-lock-pick_tiny_2.cfg sheevaplug.cfg
1318 chameleon.cfg kt-link.cfg signalyzer.cfg
1319 cortino.cfg lisa-l.cfg signalyzer-h2.cfg
1320 digilent-hs1.cfg luminary.cfg signalyzer-h4.cfg
1321 dlp-usb1232h.cfg luminary-icdi.cfg signalyzer-lite.cfg
1322 dummy.cfg luminary-lm3s811.cfg stlink-v1.cfg
1323 estick.cfg minimodule.cfg stlink-v2.cfg
1324 flashlink.cfg neodb.cfg stm32-stick.cfg
1325 flossjtag.cfg ngxtech.cfg sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg
1326 flossjtag-noeeprom.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd.cfg ti-icdi.cfg
1327 flyswatter2.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd-h.cfg turtelizer2.cfg
1328 flyswatter.cfg olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg ulink.cfg
1329 ftdi olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg usb-jtag.cfg
1330 hilscher_nxhx10_etm.cfg oocdlink.cfg usbprog.cfg
1331 hilscher_nxhx500_etm.cfg opendous.cfg vpaclink.cfg
1332 hilscher_nxhx500_re.cfg opendous_ftdi.cfg vsllink.cfg
1333 hilscher_nxhx50_etm.cfg openocd-usb.cfg xds100v2.cfg
1334
1335 interface/ftdi:
1336 axm0432.cfg hitex_str9-comstick.cfg olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg
1337 calao-usb-a9260-c01.cfg icebear.cfg oocdlink.cfg
1338 calao-usb-a9260-c02.cfg jtagkey2.cfg opendous_ftdi.cfg
1339 cortino.cfg jtagkey2p.cfg openocd-usb.cfg
1340 dlp-usb1232h.cfg jtagkey.cfg openocd-usb-hs.cfg
1341 dp_busblaster.cfg jtag-lock-pick_tiny_2.cfg openrd.cfg
1342 flossjtag.cfg kt-link.cfg redbee-econotag.cfg
1343 flossjtag-noeeprom.cfg lisa-l.cfg redbee-usb.cfg
1344 flyswatter2.cfg luminary.cfg sheevaplug.cfg
1345 flyswatter.cfg luminary-icdi.cfg signalyzer.cfg
1346 gw16042.cfg luminary-lm3s811.cfg signalyzer-lite.cfg
1347 hilscher_nxhx10_etm.cfg minimodule.cfg stm32-stick.cfg
1348 hilscher_nxhx500_etm.cfg neodb.cfg turtelizer2-revB.cfg
1349 hilscher_nxhx500_re.cfg ngxtech.cfg turtelizer2-revC.cfg
1350 hilscher_nxhx50_etm.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd.cfg vpaclink.cfg
1351 hilscher_nxhx50_re.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd-h.cfg xds100v2.cfg
1352 hitex_lpc1768stick.cfg olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg
1353 $
1354 @end example
1355 @item @file{board} ...
1356 think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1357 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1358 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1359 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1360 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1361 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1362 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1363 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1364 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1365 a CPU and an FPGA.
1366 @example
1367 $ ls board
1368 actux3.cfg lpc1850_spifi_generic.cfg
1369 am3517evm.cfg lpc4350_spifi_generic.cfg
1370 arm_evaluator7t.cfg lubbock.cfg
1371 at91cap7a-stk-sdram.cfg mcb1700.cfg
1372 at91eb40a.cfg microchip_explorer16.cfg
1373 at91rm9200-dk.cfg mini2440.cfg
1374 at91rm9200-ek.cfg mini6410.cfg
1375 at91sam9261-ek.cfg netgear-dg834v3.cfg
1376 at91sam9263-ek.cfg olimex_LPC2378STK.cfg
1377 at91sam9g20-ek.cfg olimex_lpc_h2148.cfg
1378 atmel_at91sam7s-ek.cfg olimex_sam7_ex256.cfg
1379 atmel_at91sam9260-ek.cfg olimex_sam9_l9260.cfg
1380 atmel_at91sam9rl-ek.cfg olimex_stm32_h103.cfg
1381 atmel_sam3n_ek.cfg olimex_stm32_h107.cfg
1382 atmel_sam3s_ek.cfg olimex_stm32_p107.cfg
1383 atmel_sam3u_ek.cfg omap2420_h4.cfg
1384 atmel_sam3x_ek.cfg open-bldc.cfg
1385 atmel_sam4s_ek.cfg openrd.cfg
1386 balloon3-cpu.cfg osk5912.cfg
1387 colibri.cfg phone_se_j100i.cfg
1388 crossbow_tech_imote2.cfg phytec_lpc3250.cfg
1389 csb337.cfg pic-p32mx.cfg
1390 csb732.cfg propox_mmnet1001.cfg
1391 da850evm.cfg pxa255_sst.cfg
1392 digi_connectcore_wi-9c.cfg redbee.cfg
1393 diolan_lpc4350-db1.cfg rsc-w910.cfg
1394 dm355evm.cfg sheevaplug.cfg
1395 dm365evm.cfg smdk6410.cfg
1396 dm6446evm.cfg spear300evb.cfg
1397 efikamx.cfg spear300evb_mod.cfg
1398 eir.cfg spear310evb20.cfg
1399 ek-lm3s1968.cfg spear310evb20_mod.cfg
1400 ek-lm3s3748.cfg spear320cpu.cfg
1401 ek-lm3s6965.cfg spear320cpu_mod.cfg
1402 ek-lm3s811.cfg steval_pcc010.cfg
1403 ek-lm3s811-revb.cfg stm320518_eval_stlink.cfg
1404 ek-lm3s8962.cfg stm32100b_eval.cfg
1405 ek-lm3s9b9x.cfg stm3210b_eval.cfg
1406 ek-lm3s9d92.cfg stm3210c_eval.cfg
1407 ek-lm4f120xl.cfg stm3210e_eval.cfg
1408 ek-lm4f232.cfg stm3220g_eval.cfg
1409 embedded-artists_lpc2478-32.cfg stm3220g_eval_stlink.cfg
1410 ethernut3.cfg stm3241g_eval.cfg
1411 glyn_tonga2.cfg stm3241g_eval_stlink.cfg
1412 hammer.cfg stm32f0discovery.cfg
1413 hilscher_nxdb500sys.cfg stm32f3discovery.cfg
1414 hilscher_nxeb500hmi.cfg stm32f4discovery.cfg
1415 hilscher_nxhx10.cfg stm32ldiscovery.cfg
1416 hilscher_nxhx500.cfg stm32vldiscovery.cfg
1417 hilscher_nxhx50.cfg str910-eval.cfg
1418 hilscher_nxsb100.cfg telo.cfg
1419 hitex_lpc1768stick.cfg ti_am335xevm.cfg
1420 hitex_lpc2929.cfg ti_beagleboard.cfg
1421 hitex_stm32-performancestick.cfg ti_beagleboard_xm.cfg
1422 hitex_str9-comstick.cfg ti_beaglebone.cfg
1423 iar_lpc1768.cfg ti_blaze.cfg
1424 iar_str912_sk.cfg ti_pandaboard.cfg
1425 icnova_imx53_sodimm.cfg ti_pandaboard_es.cfg
1426 icnova_sam9g45_sodimm.cfg topas910.cfg
1427 imx27ads.cfg topasa900.cfg
1428 imx27lnst.cfg twr-k60f120m.cfg
1429 imx28evk.cfg twr-k60n512.cfg
1430 imx31pdk.cfg tx25_stk5.cfg
1431 imx35pdk.cfg tx27_stk5.cfg
1432 imx53loco.cfg unknown_at91sam9260.cfg
1433 keil_mcb1700.cfg uptech_2410.cfg
1434 keil_mcb2140.cfg verdex.cfg
1435 kwikstik.cfg voipac.cfg
1436 linksys_nslu2.cfg voltcraft_dso-3062c.cfg
1437 lisa-l.cfg x300t.cfg
1438 logicpd_imx27.cfg zy1000.cfg
1439 $
1440 @end example
1441 @item @file{target} ...
1442 think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1443 on a chip
1444 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1445 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1446 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1447 the target config file defines all of them.
1448 @example
1449 $ ls target
1450 aduc702x.cfg lpc1763.cfg
1451 am335x.cfg lpc1764.cfg
1452 amdm37x.cfg lpc1765.cfg
1453 ar71xx.cfg lpc1766.cfg
1454 at32ap7000.cfg lpc1767.cfg
1455 at91r40008.cfg lpc1768.cfg
1456 at91rm9200.cfg lpc1769.cfg
1457 at91sam3ax_4x.cfg lpc1788.cfg
1458 at91sam3ax_8x.cfg lpc17xx.cfg
1459 at91sam3ax_xx.cfg lpc1850.cfg
1460 at91sam3nXX.cfg lpc2103.cfg
1461 at91sam3sXX.cfg lpc2124.cfg
1462 at91sam3u1c.cfg lpc2129.cfg
1463 at91sam3u1e.cfg lpc2148.cfg
1464 at91sam3u2c.cfg lpc2294.cfg
1465 at91sam3u2e.cfg lpc2378.cfg
1466 at91sam3u4c.cfg lpc2460.cfg
1467 at91sam3u4e.cfg lpc2478.cfg
1468 at91sam3uxx.cfg lpc2900.cfg
1469 at91sam3XXX.cfg lpc2xxx.cfg
1470 at91sam4sd32x.cfg lpc3131.cfg
1471 at91sam4sXX.cfg lpc3250.cfg
1472 at91sam4XXX.cfg lpc4350.cfg
1473 at91sam7se512.cfg lpc4350.cfg.orig
1474 at91sam7sx.cfg mc13224v.cfg
1475 at91sam7x256.cfg nuc910.cfg
1476 at91sam7x512.cfg omap2420.cfg
1477 at91sam9260.cfg omap3530.cfg
1478 at91sam9260_ext_RAM_ext_flash.cfg omap4430.cfg
1479 at91sam9261.cfg omap4460.cfg
1480 at91sam9263.cfg omap5912.cfg
1481 at91sam9.cfg omapl138.cfg
1482 at91sam9g10.cfg pic32mx.cfg
1483 at91sam9g20.cfg pxa255.cfg
1484 at91sam9g45.cfg pxa270.cfg
1485 at91sam9rl.cfg pxa3xx.cfg
1486 atmega128.cfg readme.txt
1487 avr32.cfg samsung_s3c2410.cfg
1488 c100.cfg samsung_s3c2440.cfg
1489 c100config.tcl samsung_s3c2450.cfg
1490 c100helper.tcl samsung_s3c4510.cfg
1491 c100regs.tcl samsung_s3c6410.cfg
1492 cs351x.cfg sharp_lh79532.cfg
1493 davinci.cfg smp8634.cfg
1494 dragonite.cfg spear3xx.cfg
1495 dsp56321.cfg stellaris.cfg
1496 dsp568013.cfg stellaris_icdi.cfg
1497 dsp568037.cfg stm32f0x_stlink.cfg
1498 efm32_stlink.cfg stm32f1x.cfg
1499 epc9301.cfg stm32f1x_stlink.cfg
1500 faux.cfg stm32f2x.cfg
1501 feroceon.cfg stm32f2x_stlink.cfg
1502 fm3.cfg stm32f3x.cfg
1503 hilscher_netx10.cfg stm32f3x_stlink.cfg
1504 hilscher_netx500.cfg stm32f4x.cfg
1505 hilscher_netx50.cfg stm32f4x_stlink.cfg
1506 icepick.cfg stm32l.cfg
1507 imx21.cfg stm32lx_dual_bank.cfg
1508 imx25.cfg stm32lx_stlink.cfg
1509 imx27.cfg stm32_stlink.cfg
1510 imx28.cfg stm32w108_stlink.cfg
1511 imx31.cfg stm32xl.cfg
1512 imx35.cfg str710.cfg
1513 imx51.cfg str730.cfg
1514 imx53.cfg str750.cfg
1515 imx6.cfg str912.cfg
1516 imx.cfg swj-dp.tcl
1517 is5114.cfg test_reset_syntax_error.cfg
1518 ixp42x.cfg test_syntax_error.cfg
1519 k40.cfg ti-ar7.cfg
1520 k60.cfg ti_calypso.cfg
1521 lpc1751.cfg ti_dm355.cfg
1522 lpc1752.cfg ti_dm365.cfg
1523 lpc1754.cfg ti_dm6446.cfg
1524 lpc1756.cfg tmpa900.cfg
1525 lpc1758.cfg tmpa910.cfg
1526 lpc1759.cfg u8500.cfg
1527 @end example
1528 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1529 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1530 @end itemize
1531
1532 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1533 file may override features in any of the above files by
1534 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1535 commands specific to their situation.
1536
1537 @section Interface Config Files
1538
1539 The user config file
1540 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1541
1542 @example
1543 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1544 @end example
1545
1546 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1547 in use today with OpenOCD.
1548 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1549 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1550
1551 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1552 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1553 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1554 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1555 and need to provide a driver for it.
1556
1557 @section Board Config Files
1558 @cindex config file, board
1559 @cindex board config file
1560
1561 The user config file
1562 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1563
1564 @example
1565 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1566 @end example
1567
1568 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1569 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1570 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1571
1572 @enumerate
1573 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1574 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1575 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1576 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1577 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1578 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1579 @end enumerate
1580
1581 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1582 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1583 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1584 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1585
1586 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1587 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1588 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1589 configuration works.
1590
1591 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1592
1593 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1594 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1595 convention on how to use certain variables.
1596
1597 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1598 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1599 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1600 used at will within a target configuration file.
1601
1602 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1603 for a board with three chips:
1604
1605 @example
1606 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1607 set CHIPNAME network
1608 set ENDIAN big
1609 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1610 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1611 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1612 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1613
1614 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1615 set CHIPNAME video
1616 set ENDIAN little
1617 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1618 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1619 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1620 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1621
1622 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1623 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1624 unset ENDIAN
1625 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1626 @end example
1627
1628 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1629 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1630 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1631 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1632 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1633 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1634 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1635 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1636
1637 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1638 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1639 naming collisions.
1640
1641 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1642 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1643 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1644 up other clocks and peripherals.
1645
1646 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1647 @cindex variable names
1648
1649 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1650 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1651 one such chip (as shown above).
1652 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1653 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1654 to promote consistency and
1655 so that board files can override target defaults.
1656
1657 Inputs to target config files include:
1658
1659 @itemize @bullet
1660 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1661 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1662 tap identifier dotted names.
1663 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1664 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1665 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1666 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1667 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1668 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1669 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1670 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1671 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1672 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1673 @end itemize
1674
1675 Outputs from target config files include:
1676
1677 @itemize @bullet
1678 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1679 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1680 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1681 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1682 specific to that board and that target.
1683 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1684 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1685 @end itemize
1686
1687 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1688 @cindex event, reset-init
1689 @cindex reset-init handler
1690
1691 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1692 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1693 fully set up yet.
1694 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1695 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1696 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1697 handler is one of the most important.
1698
1699 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1700 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1701 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1702 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1703 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1704
1705 @quotation Note
1706 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1707 are included here.
1708 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1709 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1710 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1711 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1712 @end quotation
1713
1714 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1715 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1716 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1717 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1718 those as parameters.
1719 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1720 and disabling the watchdog.
1721 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1722 the next developer doing such work.
1723 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1724
1725 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1726 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1727 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1728 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1729
1730 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1731
1732 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1733 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1734 a low JTAG clock rate.
1735 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1736 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1737 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1738 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1739 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1740 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1741 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1742
1743 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1744 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1745 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1746 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1747 which might be less than that.
1748
1749 @quotation Warning
1750 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1751 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1752 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1753 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1754 @end quotation
1755
1756 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1757 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1758 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1759 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1760 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1761 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1762
1763 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1764 @subsection The init_board procedure
1765 @cindex init_board procedure
1766
1767 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1768 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1769 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1770 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1771 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1772 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1773 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1774 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1775 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1776 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1777 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1778 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1779
1780 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1781 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1782
1783 @example
1784 ### board_file.cfg ###
1785
1786 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1787 source [find target/target.cfg]
1788
1789 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1790 # enables fast on-board clock source
1791 # configures the chip to use it
1792 @}
1793
1794 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1795 proc init_board @{@} @{
1796 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1797
1798 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1799 adapter_khz 1
1800 enable_fast_clock
1801 adapter_khz 10000
1802 @}
1803 @}
1804 @end example
1805
1806 @section Target Config Files
1807 @cindex config file, target
1808 @cindex target config file
1809
1810 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1811 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1812 more target config files like this:
1813
1814 @example
1815 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1816 @end example
1817
1818 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1819 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1820 In summary the target files should contain
1821
1822 @enumerate
1823 @item Set defaults
1824 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1825 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1826 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1827 @item On-Chip flash
1828 @end enumerate
1829
1830 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1831 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1832 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1833
1834 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1835 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1836 can talk to the chip.
1837 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1838 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1839 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1840 and other processing engines.
1841
1842 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1843
1844 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1845 letting board config files express environment-specific
1846 differences in how things should be set up.
1847
1848 @example
1849 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1850 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1851 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1852 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1853 @} else @{
1854 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1855 @}
1856
1857 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1858 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1859 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1860 @} else @{
1861 set _ENDIAN little
1862 @}
1863
1864 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1865 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1866 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1867 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1868 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1869 @} else @{
1870 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1871 @}
1872 @end example
1873 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1874
1875 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1876 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1877 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1878
1879 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1880 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1881 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1882
1883 @example
1884 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1885 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1886 @end example
1887
1888 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1889 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1890 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1891 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1892 for taps.
1893
1894 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1895 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1896 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1897 looks (in part) like this:
1898
1899 @example
1900 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1901 @end example
1902
1903 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1904 to source such a config file twice, with different
1905 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1906 it adds a different TAP each time.
1907
1908 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1909 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1910 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1911 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1912
1913 @example
1914 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1915 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1916 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1917 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1918 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1919 @end example
1920
1921 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1922 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1923
1924 @itemize
1925 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1926 plus a JRC to enable them
1927 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1928 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1929 is not currently used)
1930 @end itemize
1931
1932 @subsection Add CPU targets
1933
1934 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1935 GDB and other commands can use it.
1936 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1937 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1938 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1939 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1940
1941 @example
1942 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1943 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1944 @end example
1945
1946 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1947 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1948 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1949 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1950 a work area if you can.
1951 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1952
1953 @example
1954 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1955 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1956 @end example
1957
1958 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1959 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1960 @cindex SMP
1961 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1962
1963 @example
1964 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1965 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1966 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1967 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1968 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1969 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1970 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1971 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1972 @end example
1973 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1974 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1975 @itemize @bullet
1976 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1977 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1978 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1979 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1980 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1981 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1982 @end itemize
1983
1984 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1985 command have been implemented.
1986 @itemize @bullet
1987 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1988 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1989 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1990 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1991 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1992 following example.
1993 @end itemize
1994
1995 @example
1996 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1997 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1998 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1999 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
2000 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
2001 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
2002 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
2003 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
2004 > resume
2005 > cortex_a smp_gdb
2006 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
2007 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
2008 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
2009 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
2010 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
2011 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
2012 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
2013 @end example
2014
2015
2016 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
2017
2018 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
2019 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
2020 chip can be tweaked by the board.
2021
2022 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
2023 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
2024 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
2025 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
2026 both signals.
2027
2028 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
2029 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
2030 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
2031 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
2032 don't want to reset all targets at once.
2033 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
2034 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
2035 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
2036 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
2037 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
2038 not available.)
2039
2040 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
2041 they're going to be used with JTAG.
2042 An example might be needing to send some commands right
2043 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
2044 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
2045 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
2046 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
2047 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
2048
2049 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
2050 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
2051 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
2052 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
2053 slower clock than they will use later.
2054 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
2055 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
2056 than they will use later.
2057 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
2058
2059 @quotation Important
2060 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
2061 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
2062 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
2063 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
2064 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
2065 @end quotation
2066
2067 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
2068 @subsection The init_targets procedure
2069 @cindex init_targets procedure
2070
2071 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
2072 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
2073 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
2074 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
2075 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
2076 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
2077 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
2078 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
2079 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
2080
2081 @example
2082 ### generic_file.cfg ###
2083
2084 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
2085 # basic initialization procedure ...
2086 @}
2087
2088 proc init_targets @{@} @{
2089 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
2090 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
2091 @}
2092
2093 ### specific_file.cfg ###
2094
2095 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
2096
2097 proc init_targets @{@} @{
2098 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
2099 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
2100 @}
2101 @end example
2102
2103 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
2104 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
2105
2106 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
2107
2108 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
2109 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
2110
2111 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
2112 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
2113 @cindex init_target_events procedure
2114
2115 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
2116 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
2117 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
2118 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
2119 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
2120 events already assigned.
2121
2122 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
2123
2124 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
2125 special high speed download features - enable it.
2126
2127 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
2128
2129 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
2130 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
2131 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
2132 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
2133 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
2134 If you are using an external trace port,
2135 configure it in your board config file.
2136 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
2137 configure it in your target config file.
2138
2139 @example
2140 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
2141 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
2142 @end example
2143
2144 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
2145
2146 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
2147
2148 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
2149 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
2150 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
2151 the TARGET (chip) file.
2152
2153 Examples:
2154 @itemize @bullet
2155 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
2156 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
2157 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
2158 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
2159 @end itemize
2160
2161 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
2162 @section Translating Configuration Files
2163 @cindex translation
2164 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2165 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2166 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2167 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2168 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2169 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2170
2171 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2172 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2173 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2174 convert other scripts later on.
2175
2176 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2177 replace job:
2178
2179 @example
2180 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2181 #
2182 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2183 #
2184 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2185 #
2186 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2187
2188 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2189 global TARGETNAME
2190
2191 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2192
2193 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2194 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2195 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2196 @}
2197 @end example
2198
2199
2200
2201 @node Daemon Configuration
2202 @chapter Daemon Configuration
2203 @cindex initialization
2204 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2205 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2206 supported.
2207
2208 @anchor{configurationstage}
2209 @section Configuration Stage
2210 @cindex configuration stage
2211 @cindex config command
2212
2213 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2214 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2215 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2216 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2217 inside startup scripts.
2218
2219 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2220 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2221 which may be issued interactively.
2222 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2223 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2224
2225 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2226 flash banks,
2227 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2228 and other basic setup.
2229 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2230 may access or activate TAPs.
2231 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2232 longer be issued.
2233
2234 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2235 @section Entering the Run Stage
2236
2237 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2238 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2239 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2240 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2241 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2242 You should see no errors at this point.
2243 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2244 commands you used to configure the server.
2245 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2246 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2247 on the scan chain.
2248
2249 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2250 become available.
2251 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2252 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2253 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2254 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2255 entry to the run stage.
2256
2257 @deffn {Config Command} init
2258 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2259 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2260 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2261 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2262 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2263 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2264
2265 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2266 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2267 configuration files and/or command line options.
2268
2269 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2270 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2271 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2272 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2273 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2274 @end deffn
2275
2276 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2277 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2278 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2279
2280 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2281 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2282 scan chain.
2283 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2284 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2285
2286 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2287 they return.
2288 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2289 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2290 @end deffn
2291
2292 @anchor{tcpipports}
2293 @section TCP/IP Ports
2294 @cindex TCP port
2295 @cindex server
2296 @cindex port
2297 @cindex security
2298 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2299 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2300 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2301
2302 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2303 access using one or more of these ports.
2304 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2305 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2306 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2307
2308 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2309 @cindex GDB server
2310 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2311 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2312 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2313 the normal use cases.
2314
2315 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2316 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2317 disables the gdb server.
2318
2319 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2320 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2321
2322 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2323 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2324
2325 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2326 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2327 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2328
2329 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2330 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2331 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2332 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2333 @end deffn
2334
2335 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2336 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2337 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2338 output from the Tcl engine.
2339 Intended as a machine interface.
2340 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2341 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2342
2343 @end deffn
2344
2345 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2346 Specify or query the
2347 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2348 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2349 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2350 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2351 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2355 @section GDB Configuration
2356 @cindex GDB
2357 @cindex GDB configuration
2358 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2359 The ones listed here are static and global.
2360 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2361 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2362
2363 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2364 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2365 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2366 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2367 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2368 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2369 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2370 @end deffn
2371
2372 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2373 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2374 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2375 vFlash packet is received.
2376 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2380 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2381 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2382 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2383 for flash programming to work.
2384 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2385 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2389 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2390 by GDB memory read packets.
2391 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2392 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2396 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2397 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2401 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2402
2403 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @anchor{eventpolling}
2407 @section Event Polling
2408
2409 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2410 where significant events can happen at any time.
2411 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2412 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2413 or to GDB.
2414
2415 Examples of such events include:
2416
2417 @itemize
2418 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2419 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2420 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2421 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2422 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2423 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2424 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2425 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2426 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2427 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2428 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2429 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2430 @end itemize
2431
2432 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2433 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2434 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2435 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2436 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2437
2438 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2439 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2440 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2441 to the various active targets.
2442 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2443 which is normally done in the background.
2444
2445 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2446 Poll the current target for its current state.
2447 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2448 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2449 specific information about the current state is printed.
2450 An optional parameter
2451 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2452
2453 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2454 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2455 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2456 @example
2457 > poll
2458 background polling: on
2459 target state: halted
2460 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2461 current mode: Supervisor
2462 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2463 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2464 >
2465 @end example
2466 @end deffn
2467
2468 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2469 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2470 @cindex config file, interface
2471 @cindex interface config file
2472
2473 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2474 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2475 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2476
2477 @quotation Note
2478 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2479 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2480 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2481 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2482 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2483 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2484 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2485 @end quotation
2486
2487 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2488 through commands in an interface configuration
2489 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2490 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2491
2492 @example
2493 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2494 @end example
2495
2496 These commands tell
2497 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2498 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2499
2500 @example
2501 # jlink interface
2502 interface jlink
2503 @end example
2504
2505 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2506
2507
2508 @section Interface Configuration
2509
2510 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2511 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2512 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2513
2514 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2515 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2516 target.
2517 @end deffn
2518
2519 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2520 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2521 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2522 @end deffn
2523 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2524 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2525 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2526 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2527 the hardware can support.
2528 @end deffn
2529
2530
2531
2532 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2533 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2534 @end deffn
2535
2536 @section Interface Drivers
2537
2538 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2539 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2540 available at run time.
2541
2542 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2543 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2544 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2545 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2548 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2549 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2553 Displays status of RTCK option.
2554 Optionally sets that option first.
2555 @end deffn
2556 @end deffn
2557
2558 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2559 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2560 This has one driver-specific command:
2561
2562 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2563 Logs some status
2564 @end deffn
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2568 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2569 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2570 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2571 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2572 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2573 @end deffn
2574
2575 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2576 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2577
2578 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2579 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2580 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2581 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2582 @example
2583 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2584 @end example
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2588 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2589 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2590 @end deffn
2591
2592 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2593 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2594 @end deffn
2595 @end deffn
2596
2597 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2598 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2599 @end deffn
2600
2601 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2602 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2603 @end deffn
2604
2605 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2606 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2607
2608 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2609 recommended as its replacement.
2610
2611 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2612 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2613
2614 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2615 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2616 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2617 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2618 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2619 @end deffn
2620
2621 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2622 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2623 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2624 is connected to the host.
2625 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2626 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2627 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2631 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2632 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2633 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2634 @itemize @minus
2635 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2636 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2637 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2638 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2639 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2640 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2641 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2642 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2643 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2644 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2645 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2646 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2647 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2648 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2649 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2650 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2651 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2652 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2653 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2654 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2655 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2656 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2657 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2658 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2659 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2660 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2661 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2662 @end itemize
2663 @end deffn
2664
2665 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2666 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2667 default values are used.
2668 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2669 @example
2670 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2671 @end example
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2675 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2676 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2677 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2678 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2679 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2680 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2681 @end deffn
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2684 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2685 The default value is 1.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 For example, the interface config file for a
2689 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2690
2691 @example
2692 interface ft2232
2693 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2694 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2695 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2696 @end example
2697 @end deffn
2698
2699 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2700 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2701 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2702 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2703 interface driver.
2704
2705 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2706 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2707 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2708
2709 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2710 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2711 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2712
2713 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2714 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2715 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2716 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2717 will be used for their customary purpose.
2718
2719 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2720 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2721 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2722 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2723
2724 @itemize @minus
2725 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2726 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2727 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2728 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2729 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2730 switching data and direction as necessary
2731 @end itemize
2732
2733 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2734 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2735
2736 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2737 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2738 default values are used.
2739 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2740 @example
2741 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2742 @end example
2743 @end deffn
2744
2745 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2746 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2747 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2748 during device selection.
2749 @end deffn
2750
2751 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2752 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2753 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2754 is connected to the host.
2755 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2756 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2757 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2761 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2762 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2766 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2767 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2768 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2769 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2770 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2771 and initially asserted reset signals.
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2775 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2776 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2777 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2778 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2779 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2780 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2781 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2782 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2783
2784 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2785 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2786 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2787 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2788 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2789 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2790
2791 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2792 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2793 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2794 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2795 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2796 are always driven by the FTDI.
2797
2798 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2799 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2800 @var{name}.
2801 @end deffn
2802
2803 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2804 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2805 @itemize @minus
2806 @item @option{0}, drive low
2807 @item @option{1}, drive high
2808 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2809 @end itemize
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2813 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2814 @end deffn
2815
2816 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2817 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2818 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2819 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2820
2821 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2822 processors which are being simulated.
2823
2824 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2825 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2826 sockets instead of TCP.
2827 @end deffn
2828
2829 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2830 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2831 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2832 @end deffn
2833
2834 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2835 something like:
2836
2837 @example
2838 interface remote_bitbang
2839 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2840 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2841 @end example
2842
2843 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2844 named mysocket:
2845
2846 @example
2847 interface remote_bitbang
2848 remote_bitbang_port 0
2849 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2850 @end example
2851 @end deffn
2852
2853 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2854 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2855 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2856 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2857
2858 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2859 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2860 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2861 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2862 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2863 @end deffn
2864
2865 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2866 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2867 default values are used.
2868 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2869 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2870 @example
2871 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2872 @end example
2873 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2874 @example
2875 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2876 @end example
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1})
2880 Sets the state of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters (pins 6 and 8 on the
2881 female JTAG header). These pins can be used as SRST and/or TRST provided the
2882 appropriate connections are made on the target board.
2883
2884 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST (as with an AVR board):
2885 @example
2886 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-assert \
2887 "usb_blaster pin6 1; wait 1; usb_blaster pin6 0"
2888 @end example
2889 @end deffn
2890
2891 @end deffn
2892
2893 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2894 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2895 This has one driver-specific command:
2896
2897 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2898 Display either the address of the I/O port
2899 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2900 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2901 This is a write-once setting.
2902 @end deffn
2903 @end deffn
2904
2905 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2906 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2907
2908 @quotation Compatibility Note
2909 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2910 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2911 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2912 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2913 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2914 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2915 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2916 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2917 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2918 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2919 @end quotation
2920
2921 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2922 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2923 @end deffn
2924 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2925 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2926 @end deffn
2927 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2928 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2929 @end deffn
2930 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2931 Display the J-Link configuration.
2932 @end deffn
2933 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2934 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2935 @end deffn
2936 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2937 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2938 @end deffn
2939 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2940 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2941 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2942 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2943 @end deffn
2944 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2945 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2946 @end deffn
2947 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2948 Reset the current configuration.
2949 @end deffn
2950 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2951 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2952 @end deffn
2953 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2954 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2955 @end deffn
2956 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2957 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2958 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2959
2960 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2961 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2962 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2963
2964 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2965 @end deffn
2966 @end deffn
2967
2968 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2969 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2970 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2971 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2972 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2973
2974 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2975 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2976 This is a write-once setting.
2977 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2978
2979 @itemize @minus
2980 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2981 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2982 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2983 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2984 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2985 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2986 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2987 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2988 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2989 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2990 some versions of
2991 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2992 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2993 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2994 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2995 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2996 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2997 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2998 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2999 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3000 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3001 @end itemize
3002 @end deffn
3003
3004 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
3005 Display either the address of the I/O port
3006 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3007 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3008 This is a write-once setting.
3009
3010 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3011 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3012 you may encounter a problem.
3013 @end deffn
3014
3015 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3016 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3017 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3018 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
3019 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3020 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3021
3022 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3023 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3024 @quotation Tip
3025 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3026 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3027 @example
3028 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3029 > adapter_khz 500
3030 @end example
3031 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3032 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3033 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3034 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3035 large set of samples.
3036 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3037 @example
3038 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3039 @end example
3040 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3041 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3042
3043 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3044 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3045 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3046 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3047 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3048 @end quotation
3049 @end deffn
3050
3051 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3052 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3053 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3054 @end deffn
3055
3056 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3057 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3058
3059 @example
3060 interface parport
3061 parport_port 0x278
3062 parport_cable wiggler
3063 @end example
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3067 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3068 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3069 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3070 @end deffn
3071 @end deffn
3072
3073 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3074 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3075 @end deffn
3076
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3078 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3082 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3083
3084 @quotation Note
3085 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3086 which are not currently documented here.
3087 @end quotation
3088 @end deffn
3089
3090 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3091 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3092 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3093 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3094
3095 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
3096 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3097 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3098 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
3099 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3100
3101 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3102 Currently Not Supported.
3103 @end deffn
3104
3105 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3106 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3107 @end deffn
3108
3109 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3110 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
3114 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
3115 @end deffn
3116
3117 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3118 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3119 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Config Command} {trace} source_clock_hz [output_file_path]
3123 Enable SWO tracing (if supported). The source clock rate for the
3124 trace port must be specified, this is typically the CPU clock rate. If
3125 the optional output file is specified then raw trace data is appended
3126 to the file, and the file is created if it does not exist.
3127 @end deffn
3128 @end deffn
3129
3130 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3131 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3135 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3136 @end deffn
3137
3138 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3139 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3140 @end deffn
3141
3142 @quotation Note
3143 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3144 which are not currently documented here.
3145 @end quotation
3146
3147 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3148 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3149 No arguments: print status.
3150 @end deffn
3151
3152 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3153 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3154 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3155
3156 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3157 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3158 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3159 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3160 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3161 configuration on exit.
3162
3163 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3164 pinout.
3165
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @section Transport Configuration
3169 @cindex Transport
3170 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3171 and the debug adapter you are using,
3172 several transports may be available to
3173 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3174 @deffn Command {transport list}
3175 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3176 version of OpenOCD.
3177 @end deffn
3178
3179 @deffn Command {transport select} transport_name
3180 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3181 The transport must be supported by the debug adapter hardware and by the
3182 version of OpenOCD you are using (including the adapter's driver).
3183 No arguments: returns name of session's selected transport.
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @subsection JTAG Transport
3187 @cindex JTAG
3188 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3189 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3190 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3191 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3192 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3193 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3194 @subsection SWD Transport
3195 @cindex SWD
3196 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3197 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3198 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3199 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3200 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3201 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3202 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3203 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3204 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3205 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3206 expected to change.
3207 @end deffn
3208 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3209 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3210 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3211 No parameters: displays current settings.
3212 @end deffn
3213
3214 @subsection CMSIS-DAP Transport
3215 @cindex CMSIS-DAP
3216 CMSIS-DAP is an ARM-specific transport that is used to connect to
3217 compilant debuggers.
3218
3219 @subsection SPI Transport
3220 @cindex SPI
3221 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3222 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3223 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3224 solution for flash programming.
3225
3226 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3227 @section JTAG Speed
3228 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3229 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3230 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3231 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3232 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3233 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3234 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3235 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3236 power management software that may be active.
3237
3238 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3239 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3240 target event handler.
3241 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3242 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3243 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3244 sets up those clocks).
3245 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3246 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3247 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3248 in the target config file.
3249 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3250 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3251 config file instead.
3252 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3253 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3254 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3255
3256 @example
3257 jtag_rclk 3000
3258 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3259 @end example
3260
3261 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3262 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3263 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3264 may not be the fastest solution.
3265
3266 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3267 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3268 which support adaptive clocking.
3269
3270 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3271 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3272 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3273 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3274 than the speed specified.
3275
3276 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3277 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3278 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3279 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3280
3281 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3282 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3283 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3284 JTAG clocking after setup.
3285 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3286 If the interface device can not
3287 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3288 @end deffn
3289
3290 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3291 @cindex adaptive clocking
3292 @cindex RTCK
3293 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3294 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3295 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3296 @example
3297 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3298 jtag_rclk 3000
3299 @end example
3300 @end defun
3301
3302 @node Reset Configuration
3303 @chapter Reset Configuration
3304 @cindex Reset Configuration
3305
3306 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3307 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3308 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3309 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3310 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3311 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3312 Please see the various board files for examples.
3313
3314 @quotation Note
3315 To maintainers and integrators:
3316 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3317 Normally the board configuration file
3318 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3319 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3320
3321 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3322 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3323 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3324 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3325 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3326 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3327 @end quotation
3328
3329 @section Types of Reset
3330
3331 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3332 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3333 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3334
3335 @itemize @bullet
3336 @item
3337 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3338 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3339 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3340 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3341 @item
3342 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3343 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3344 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3345 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3346 @item
3347 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3348 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3349 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3350 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3351 @item
3352 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3353 several other types of reset.
3354 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3355 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3356 There may be individual module resets.
3357 @end itemize
3358
3359 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3360 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3361 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3362 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3363 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3364 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3365 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3366 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3367 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3368
3369 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3370 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3371
3372 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3373 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3374 common issues are:
3375
3376 @itemize @bullet
3377
3378 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3379 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3380 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3381 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3382 when either of those signals is not connected.
3383 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3384 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3385 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3386 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3387
3388 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3389 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3390 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3391 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3392
3393 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3394 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3395 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3396 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3397 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3398 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3399 hardware debouncing.
3400 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3401 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3402
3403 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3404 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3405 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3406 to use push/pull output drivers.
3407 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3408 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3409 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3410 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3411
3412 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3413 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3414 issues (not limited to errata).
3415 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3416 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3417 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3418 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3419 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3420 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3421 @end itemize
3422
3423 There can also be other issues.
3424 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3425 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3426 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3427 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3428 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3429 Agreement (NDA).
3430
3431 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3432 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3433 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3434
3435 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3436 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3437
3438 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3439
3440 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3441 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3442 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3443 allowing it to be deasserted.
3444 @end deffn
3445
3446 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3447 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3448 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3449 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3450 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3451 @end deffn
3452
3453 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3454 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3455 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3456 allowing it to be deasserted.
3457 @end deffn
3458
3459 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3460 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3461 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3462 @end deffn
3463
3464 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3465 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3466 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3467 configuration scripts.
3468
3469 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3470 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3471 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3472 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3473 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3474 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3475 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3476 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3477
3478 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3479 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3480 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3481 -- may be specified at a time.
3482 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3483 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3484 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3485 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3486 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3487
3488 @itemize
3489 @item
3490 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3491 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3492 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3493 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3494 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3495
3496 @quotation Tip
3497 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3498 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3499 @end quotation
3500
3501 @item
3502 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3503 signal implementations.
3504 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3505 indicating everything behaves normally.
3506 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3507 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3508 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3509 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3510 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3511 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3512 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3513
3514 @item
3515 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3516 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3517 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3518 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3519 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3520 while SRST is asserted.
3521 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3522 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3523
3524 @item
3525 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3526 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3527 is required to use this option.
3528 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3529 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3530 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3531 be asserted before any target connection.
3532 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3533 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3534 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3535 @end itemize
3536
3537 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3538 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3539 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3540 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3541 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3542
3543 @itemize
3544 @item
3545 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3546 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3547 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3548 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3549
3550 @item
3551 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3552 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3553 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3554 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3555 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3556 @end itemize
3557 @end deffn
3558
3559 @section Custom Reset Handling
3560 @cindex events
3561
3562 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3563 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3564 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3565 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3566 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3567 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3568
3569 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3570 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3571 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3572 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3573 want to reset everything at once.
3574
3575 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3576 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3577 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3578 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3579 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3580 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3581 needs special attention.
3582
3583 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3584 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3585 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3586 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3587 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3588 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3589 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3590 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3591
3592 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3593 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3594 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3595 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3596 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3597
3598 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3599 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3600 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3601 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3602 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3603 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3604 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3605 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3606 or potentially some other value.
3607
3608 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3609 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3610 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3611 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3612 (or their associated targets)
3613 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3614
3615 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3616 they return.
3617 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3618 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3619 @end deffn
3620
3621 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3622 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3623 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3624 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3625 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3626 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3627 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3628 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3629 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3630 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3631 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3632 @end deffn
3633
3634 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3635 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3636 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3637 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3638 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3639 @end deffn
3640
3641
3642 @node TAP Declaration
3643 @chapter TAP Declaration
3644 @cindex TAP declaration
3645 @cindex TAP configuration
3646
3647 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3648 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3649
3650 @itemize @bullet
3651 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3652 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3653 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3654 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3655 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3656 start running that code.
3657 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3658 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3659 and missing connections.
3660 @end itemize
3661
3662 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3663 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3664 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3665 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3666 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3667
3668 @section Scan Chains
3669 @cindex scan chain
3670
3671 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3672 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3673 They also need to be added to
3674 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3675 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3676 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3677 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3678 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3679 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3680 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3681 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3682
3683 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3684 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3685 command, presented in the next chapter.
3686 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3687 debugging targets.)
3688 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3689
3690 @verbatim
3691 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3692 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3693 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3694 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3695 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3696 @end verbatim
3697
3698 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3699 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3700 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3701 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3702 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3703 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3704 until they are told to do so.
3705
3706 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3707 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3708 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3709 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3710
3711 @example
3712 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3713 @end example
3714
3715 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3716 by a given chip.
3717 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3718 and so forth.
3719 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3720 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3721 both inside a single chip and between them.
3722 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3723
3724 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3725 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3726 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3727 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3728 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3729 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3730 includes commands something like this:
3731
3732 @example
3733 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3734 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3735 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3736 @end example
3737
3738 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3739 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3740 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3741
3742 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3743 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3744 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3745 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3746 @example
3747 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3748 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3749 @}
3750 @end example
3751 @end deffn
3752
3753 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3754 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3755 and their status.
3756 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3757 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3758 but systems with a JTAG router can
3759 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3760 @end deffn
3761
3762 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3763 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3764
3765 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3766 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3767
3768 @section TAP Names
3769 @cindex dotted name
3770
3771 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3772 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3773 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3774 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3775 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3776 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3777 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3778 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3779
3780 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3781 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3782 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3783
3784 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3785
3786 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3787 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3788 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3789 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3790
3791 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3792 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3793 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3794 overridable.
3795
3796 @cindex TAP naming convention
3797 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3798 and should follow this convention:
3799
3800 @itemize @bullet
3801 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3802 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3803 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3804 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3805 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3806 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3807 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3808 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3809 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3810 with a single TAP;
3811 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3812 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3813 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3814 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3815 @end itemize
3816
3817 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3818
3819 @itemize @bullet
3820 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3821 @*The length in bits of the
3822 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3823 @end itemize
3824
3825 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3826
3827 @itemize @bullet
3828 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3829 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3830 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3831 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3832 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3833 (the TAP is linked in).
3834 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3835 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3836 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3837 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3838 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3839 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3840 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3841 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3842 values that were found but not included in the list.
3843
3844 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3845 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3846 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3847 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3848 hardware to find these values.
3849 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3850 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3851 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3852 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3853 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3854 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3855 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3856 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3857 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3858 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3859 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3860 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3861 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3862 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3863 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3864 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3865 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3866 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3867 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3868 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3869 @end itemize
3870 @end deffn
3871
3872 @section Other TAP commands
3873
3874 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3875 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3876 At this writing this TAP attribute
3877 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3878 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3879 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3880 See the next section for information about the available events.
3881
3882 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3883 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3884 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3885 @end deffn
3886
3887 @section TAP Events
3888 @cindex events
3889 @cindex TAP events
3890
3891 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3892 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3893 The other applies to debugger targets,
3894 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3895
3896 The TAP events currently defined are:
3897
3898 @itemize @bullet
3899 @item @b{post-reset}
3900 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3901 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3902 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3903 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3904 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3905
3906 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3907 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3908 of any particular target.
3909 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3910 @item @b{setup}
3911 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3912 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3913 @item @b{tap-disable}
3914 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3915 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3916 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3917 @item @b{tap-enable}
3918 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3919 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3920 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3921 @end itemize
3922
3923 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3924 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3925 contents to be accurate), you might:
3926
3927 @example
3928 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3929 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3930 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3931 @}
3932 @end example
3933
3934
3935 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3936 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3937 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3938 @cindex jrc
3939
3940 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3941 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3942 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3943 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3944 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3945
3946 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3947 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3948 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3949 be visible.
3950 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3951 ignores, such as:
3952
3953 @itemize
3954 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3955 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3956 TAPs receive new instructions.
3957 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3958 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3959 @end itemize
3960
3961 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3962 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3963 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3964 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3965
3966 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3967 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3968
3969 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3970 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3971 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3972 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3973 should define TAP event handlers using
3974 code that looks something like this:
3975
3976 @example
3977 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3978 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3979 @}
3980 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3981 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3982 @}
3983 @end example
3984
3985 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3986
3987 @example
3988 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3989 @end example
3990
3991 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3992 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3993 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3994 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3995
3996 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3997 If necessary, disables the tap
3998 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3999 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4000 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4001 and "0" if it is disabled.
4002 @end deffn
4003
4004 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4005 If necessary, enables the tap
4006 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4007 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4008 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4009 and "0" if it is disabled.
4010 @end deffn
4011
4012 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4013 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4014 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4015 and "0" if it is disabled.
4016
4017 @quotation Note
4018 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4019 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4020 @end quotation
4021 @end deffn
4022
4023 @anchor{autoprobing}
4024 @section Autoprobing
4025 @cindex autoprobe
4026 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4027
4028 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4029 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4030 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4031 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4032
4033 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4034 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4035 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4036 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4037 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4038 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4039 right when they come out of reset).
4040
4041 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4042
4043 @example
4044 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4045 reset_config trst_and_srst
4046 jtag_rclk 8
4047 @end example
4048
4049 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4050 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4051
4052 @enumerate
4053 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4054 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4055 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4056 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4057 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4058 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4059 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4060 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4061 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4062 that is discovered.
4063 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4064 register, it will report it.
4065 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4066 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4067 @end enumerate
4068
4069 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4070 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4071 that's a bit more complex:
4072
4073 @example
4074 clock speed 8 kHz
4075 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4076 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4077 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4078 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4079 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4080 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4081 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4082 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4083 @end example
4084
4085 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4086 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4087 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4088 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4089 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4090 and so forth.
4091
4092 @node CPU Configuration
4093 @chapter CPU Configuration
4094 @cindex GDB target
4095
4096 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4097 You can also access these targets without GDB
4098 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4099 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4100 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4101 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4102
4103 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4104 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4105
4106 @section Target List
4107 @cindex target, current
4108 @cindex target, list
4109
4110 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4111 where each member has a name.
4112 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4113 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4114 (plural!) command.
4115 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4116 look like with more than one:
4117 @verbatim
4118 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4119 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4120 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4121 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4122 @end verbatim
4123
4124 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4125 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4126 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4127 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4128 space seen by that current target.
4129 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4130 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4131 are examples; and there are many more.
4132
4133 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4134
4135 @deffn Command {target count}
4136 @emph{Note: target numbers are deprecated; don't use them.
4137 They will be removed shortly after August 2010, including this command.
4138 Iterate target using @command{target names}, not by counting.}
4139
4140 Returns the number of targets, @math{N}.
4141 The highest numbered target is @math{N - 1}.
4142 @example
4143 set c [target count]
4144 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < $c @} @{ incr x @} @{
4145 # Assuming you have created this function
4146 print_target_details $x
4147 @}
4148 @end example
4149 @end deffn
4150
4151 @deffn Command {target current}
4152 Returns the name of the current target.
4153 @end deffn
4154
4155 @deffn Command {target names}
4156 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4157 @example
4158 foreach t [target names] @{
4159 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4160 @}
4161 @end example
4162 @end deffn
4163
4164 @deffn Command {target number} number
4165 @emph{Note: target numbers are deprecated; don't use them.
4166 They will be removed shortly after August 2010, including this command.}
4167
4168 The list of targets is numbered starting at zero.
4169 This command returns the name of the target at index @var{number}.
4170 @example
4171 set thename [target number $x]
4172 puts [format "Target %d is: %s\n" $x $thename]
4173 @end example
4174 @end deffn
4175
4176 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4177 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4178
4179 @deffn Command targets [name]
4180 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4181 command names are singular.}
4182
4183 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4184 targets in a user friendly form.
4185
4186 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4187 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4188 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4189 @end deffn
4190
4191 @section Target CPU Types
4192 @cindex target type
4193 @cindex CPU type
4194
4195 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4196 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4197 when calling @command{target create}.
4198 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4199 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4200 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4201 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4202 what core-specific commands may be available
4203 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4204 and more.
4205
4206 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4207 since there's a command to list them.
4208
4209 @anchor{targettypes}
4210 @deffn Command {target types}
4211 Lists all supported target types.
4212 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4213
4214 @itemize @bullet
4215 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4216 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4217 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4218 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4219 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4220 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4221 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4222 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4223 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4224 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4225 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4226 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4227 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4228 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4229 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4230 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4231 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4232 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4233 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4234 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4235 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4236 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4237 @itemize @minus
4238 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4239 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @emph{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4240 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @emph{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4241 @end itemize
4242 And two debug interfaces cores:
4243 @itemize @minus
4244 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4245 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4246 @end itemize
4247 @end itemize
4248 @end deffn
4249
4250 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4251 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4252 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4253 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4254 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4255 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4256 reflect design generations;
4257 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4258 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4259
4260 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4261 @section Target Configuration
4262
4263 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4264 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4265 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4266 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4267 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4268
4269 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4270 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4271 optional parts.
4272 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4273 command, created as part of target creation.
4274
4275 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4276 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4277 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4278 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4279 to be much more board-specific.
4280 The key steps you use might look something like this
4281
4282 @example
4283 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4284 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4285 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4286 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4287 @end example
4288
4289 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4290 on-chip SRAM.
4291 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4292 writes to target memory;
4293 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4294 GDB memory checksumming;
4295 and more.
4296
4297 @quotation Warning
4298 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4299 inaccessible when application code
4300 (such as an operating system)
4301 enables or disables the MMU.
4302 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4303 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4304 easy access to other addresses needed.
4305 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4306 @end quotation
4307
4308 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4309 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4310 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4311 controllers.
4312 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4313 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4314 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4315
4316 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4317 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4318 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4319 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4320 purposes including additional configuration.
4321
4322 @itemize @bullet
4323 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4324 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4325 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4326 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4327
4328 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4329 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4330 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4331 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4332 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4333 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4334 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4335
4336 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4337 @end itemize
4338 @end deffn
4339
4340 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4341 The options accepted by this command may also be
4342 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4343 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4344 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4345
4346 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4347 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4348 and changing its endianness.
4349
4350 @itemize @bullet
4351
4352 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4353 used to access this target.
4354
4355 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4356 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4357
4358 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4359 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4360 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4361 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4362 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4363 same event name assigns only one handler.
4364
4365 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4366 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4367 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4368 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4369 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4370 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4371 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4372
4373 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4374 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4375 or virtual address is being used.
4376
4377 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4378 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4379
4380 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4381 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4382 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4383 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4384 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4385
4386 @anchor{rtostype}
4387 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4388 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4389 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}
4390 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4391
4392 @end itemize
4393 @end deffn
4394
4395 @section Other $target_name Commands
4396 @cindex object command
4397
4398 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4399 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4400
4401 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4402 Once a button is created a button
4403 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4404 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4405 configure it like this:
4406
4407 @example
4408 # Create
4409 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4410 # Modify
4411 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4412 # Query
4413 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4414 # Report
4415 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4416 @end example
4417
4418 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4419 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4420
4421 @example
4422 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4423 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4424 @end example
4425
4426 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4427
4428 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4429 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4430 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4431 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4432 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4433 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4434 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4435 They are not otherwise documented here.
4436 @end deffn
4437
4438 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4439 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4440 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4441 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4442 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4443 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4444 the target side uses raw memory.
4445
4446 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4447 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4448 The script orientation comes from working with data
4449 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4450 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4451 and neither store nor return those values.
4452
4453 @itemize
4454 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4455 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4456 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4457 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4458 @end itemize
4459 @end deffn
4460
4461 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4462 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4463 @command{$target_name configure}
4464 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4465 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4466 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4467 There are a few special cases:
4468
4469 @itemize @bullet
4470 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4471 event named @var{event_name}.
4472 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4473 two parameters.
4474 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4475 This is a special case because this is set using
4476 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4477 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4478 @end itemize
4479
4480 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4481 all the targets you might use something like this:
4482
4483 @example
4484 foreach name [target names] @{
4485 set y [$name cget -endian]
4486 set z [$name cget -type]
4487 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4488 $x $name $y $z]
4489 @}
4490 @end example
4491 @end deffn
4492
4493 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4494 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4495 Displays the current target state:
4496 @code{debug-running},
4497 @code{halted},
4498 @code{reset},
4499 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4500 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4501 @end deffn
4502
4503 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4504 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4505 currently associated with this target.
4506 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4507 @end deffn
4508
4509 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4510 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4511 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4512 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4513 @end deffn
4514
4515 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4516 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4517 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4518 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4519 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4520 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4521 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4522 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4523 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4524 @end deffn
4525
4526 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4527 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4528 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4529 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4530 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4531 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4532 @end deffn
4533
4534 @anchor{targetevents}
4535 @section Target Events
4536 @cindex target events
4537 @cindex events
4538 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4539 For example:
4540 @itemize @bullet
4541 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4542 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4543 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4544 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4545 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4546 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4547 to set up system clocks or
4548 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4549 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4550 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4551 @end itemize
4552
4553 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4554 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4555 @command{target create ... -event}.
4556
4557 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4558 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4559 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4560
4561 @example
4562 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4563 echo "Reset..."
4564 reset halt
4565 @}
4566 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4567 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4568 echo "Reset..."
4569 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work we need a reset init.
4570 reset init
4571 @}
4572 @end example
4573
4574 The following target events are defined:
4575
4576 @itemize @bullet
4577 @item @b{debug-halted}
4578 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4579 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4580 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4581 @item @b{early-halted}
4582 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4583 @item @b{examine-start}
4584 @* Before target examine is called.
4585 @item @b{examine-end}
4586 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4587 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4588 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4589 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4590 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4591 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4592 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4593 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4594 @* When GDB disconnects
4595 @item @b{gdb-end}
4596 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4597 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4598 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4599 @code{reset init})
4600 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4601 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4602 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4603 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4604 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4605 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4606 @item @b{gdb-start}
4607 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4608 @item @b{halted}
4609 @* The target has halted
4610 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4611 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4612 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4613 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4614 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4615 @item @b{reset-assert}
4616 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4617 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4618 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4619 it instead of asserting SRST.
4620 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4621 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4622 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4623 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4624 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4625 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4626 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4627 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4628 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4629 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4630 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4631 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4632 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4633 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4634 released on the scan chain.
4635 @item @b{reset-end}
4636 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4637 @ignore
4638 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4639 @* Currently not used
4640 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4641 @* Currently not used
4642 @end ignore
4643 @item @b{reset-init}
4644 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4645 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4646
4647 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4648 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4649 multiplexing, and so on.
4650 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4651 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4652 @item @b{reset-start}
4653 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4654 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4655
4656 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4657 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4658 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4659 @ignore
4660 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4661 @* Currently not used
4662 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4663 @* Currently not used
4664 @end ignore
4665 @item @b{resume-start}
4666 @* Before any target is resumed
4667 @item @b{resume-end}
4668 @* After all targets have resumed
4669 @item @b{resumed}
4670 @* Target has resumed
4671 @end itemize
4672
4673 @node Flash Commands
4674 @chapter Flash Commands
4675
4676 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4677 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4678 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4679 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4680 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4681 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4682 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4683 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4684 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4685
4686 Flash Steps:
4687 @enumerate
4688 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4689 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4690 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4691 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4692 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4693 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4694 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4695 @item GDB Flashing
4696 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4697 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4698 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4699 @end enumerate
4700
4701 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4702 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4703 so that it can't boot.
4704 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4705 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4706
4707 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4708 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4709 @cindex flash configuration
4710
4711 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4712 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4713 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4714 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4715 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4716 see the driver-specific documentation.
4717
4718 @itemize @bullet
4719 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4720 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4721 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4722 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4723 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4724 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4725 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4726 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4727 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4728 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4729 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4730 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4731 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4732 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4733 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4734 commands to the flash controller.
4735 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4736 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4737 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4738 for more information.
4739 @end itemize
4740 @quotation Note
4741 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4742 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4743 @end quotation
4744 @end deffn
4745
4746 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4747 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4748 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4749 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4750 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4751 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4752 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4753 @end deffn
4754
4755 @deffn Command {flash list}
4756 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4757 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4758 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4762 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4763 depends on the flash type.
4764 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4765 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4766 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4767 but most don't bother.
4768 @end deffn
4769
4770 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4771 @cindex flash erasing
4772 @cindex flash reading
4773 @cindex flash writing
4774 @cindex flash programming
4775 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4776
4777 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4778 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4779 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4780 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4781 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4782
4783 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4784 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4785 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4786 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4787 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4788
4789 @quotation Note
4790 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4791 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4792 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4793 back to a flash bank.
4794 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4795 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4796 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4797 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4798 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4799 @end quotation
4800
4801 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4802 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4803 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4804 disabled first.
4805 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4806 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4807 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4808
4809 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4810 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4811 up to and including @var{last}.
4812 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4813 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4814 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4815 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4816 @end deffn
4817
4818 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4819 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4820 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4821 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4822 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4823 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4824 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4825 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4826 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4827 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4828 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4829 before erase starts.
4830 @end deffn
4831
4832 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4833 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4834 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4835 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4836 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4837 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4838 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4839 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4840 before issuing this command.
4841 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4842 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4843 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4844 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4845 @end deffn
4846 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4847
4848 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4849 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4850 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4851 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4852 @end deffn
4853
4854 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4855 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4856 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4857 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4858 to the base address for each section in the image.
4859 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4860 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4861 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4862 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4863 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4864 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4865 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4866 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4867 each image section.
4868
4869 @quotation Warning
4870 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4871 data you want to preserve.
4872 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4873 sections might be erased with no notice.
4874 @itemize
4875 @item
4876 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4877 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4878 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4879 @item
4880 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4881 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4882 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4883 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4884 @end itemize
4885 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4886 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4887 @end quotation
4888
4889 @end deffn
4890
4891 @section Other Flash commands
4892 @cindex flash protection
4893
4894 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4895 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4896 and display that status.
4897 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4898 @end deffn
4899
4900 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4901 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4902 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4903 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4904 and possibly stale information.
4905 @end deffn
4906
4907 @anchor{flashprotect}
4908 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4909 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4910 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4911 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4912 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4913 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4914 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4915 @end deffn
4916
4917 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4918 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4919 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4920 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4921 @end deffn
4922
4923 @anchor{program}
4924 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [offset]
4925 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4926 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4927 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4928 @end deffn
4929
4930 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4931 @section Flash Driver List
4932 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4933 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4934 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4935
4936 @subsection External Flash
4937
4938 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4939 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4940 @cindex CFI
4941 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4942 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4943 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4944 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4945 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4946 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4947 configure a bus and its timings), or
4948 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4949 on the flash chip.
4950 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4951 speed up operation.
4952
4953 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4954
4955 @itemize
4956 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4957 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4958 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4959 @end itemize
4960
4961 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4962 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4963
4964 @example
4965 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4966 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4967 @end example
4968
4969 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4970 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4971 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4972
4973 @example
4974 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4975 @end example
4976
4977 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4978 @end deffn
4979
4980 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4981 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4982 @cindex SPIFI
4983 @cindex lpcspifi
4984 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4985 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4986 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4987
4988 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4989 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4990 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4991 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4992 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4993
4994 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4995 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4996 are configured by the driver.
4997
4998 @example
4999 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5000 @end example
5001
5002 @end deffn
5003
5004 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5005 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5006 @cindex SMI
5007 @cindex stmsmi
5008 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5009 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5010 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5011 SPI flash devices.
5012 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5013 flash devices can be connected.
5014
5015 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5016 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5017 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5018 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5019 the flash content.
5020
5021 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5022 to identify the memory bank.
5023 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5024 flash size, are detected automatically.
5025
5026 @example
5027 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5028 @end example
5029
5030 @end deffn
5031
5032 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5033
5034 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5035 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5036 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5037 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5038 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5039 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5040
5041 @example
5042 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5043 @end example
5044 @end deffn
5045
5046 @anchor{at91samd}
5047 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5048 @cindex at91samd
5049
5050 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5051 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5052 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5053 processor to be halted.
5054 @end deffn
5055
5056 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5057 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5058 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5059 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5060 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5061 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5062
5063 @example
5064 at91samd set-security enable
5065 @end example
5066 @end deffn
5067
5068 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5069 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5070 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5071 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5072 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5073 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5074 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5075 in order to disable this feature.
5076
5077 @example
5078 at91samd eeprom
5079 at91samd eeprom 1024
5080 @end example
5081 @end deffn
5082
5083 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5084 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5085 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5086 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5087 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5088 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5089
5090 @example
5091 at91samd bootloader
5092 at91samd bootloader 16384
5093 @end example
5094 @end deffn
5095
5096 @end deffn
5097
5098 @anchor{at91sam3}
5099 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5100 @cindex at91sam3
5101 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5102 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5103 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5104 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5105 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5106 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5107 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5108 chips are confirmed.}
5109
5110 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5111 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5112 the following fixed locations:
5113
5114 @example
5115 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5116 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5117 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5118 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5119 @end example
5120
5121 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5122 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5123 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5124
5125 @itemize
5126 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5127 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5128 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5129 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5130 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5131 @end itemize
5132
5133 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5134
5135 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5136 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5137 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5138 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5139 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5140 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5141 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5142
5143 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5144 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5145 @end deffn
5146
5147 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5148 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5149 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5150 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5151 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5152 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5153 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5154 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5155 @end deffn
5156
5157 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5158 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5159 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5160 @end deffn
5161 @end deffn
5162
5163 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5164 @cindex at91sam4
5165 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5166 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5167 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5168 @end deffn
5169
5170 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5171 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5172 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5173 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5174 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5175
5176 @example
5177 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5178 @end example
5179
5180 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5181 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5182
5183 @itemize
5184 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5185 @item @var{banks}
5186 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5187 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5188 @item @var{pages_size}
5189 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5190 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5191 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5192 @end itemize
5193
5194 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5195 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5196 will be autoconfigured.
5197 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5198
5199 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5200 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5201 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5202 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5203 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5204
5205 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5206 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5207 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5208 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5209 are not truly general purpose).
5210 @quotation Note
5211 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5212 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5213 @end quotation
5214 @end deffn
5215 @end deffn
5216
5217 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5218 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5219 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5220 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5221 @end deffn
5222
5223 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5224 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5225 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5226 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5227 autoconfigures itself.
5228 @example
5229 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5230 @end example
5231 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5232 supported.}
5233 @end deffn
5234
5235 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5236 All members of the LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members
5237 of the LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000 and LPC4300 microcontroller families from NXP
5238 include internal flash and use Cortex-M0 (LPC11(x)00), Cortex-M3 (LPC1300, LPC1700,
5239 LPC1800), Cortex-M4 (LPC4300) or ARM7TDMI (LPC2000) cores.
5240
5241 @quotation Note
5242 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5243 driver:
5244 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5245 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5246 @end quotation
5247
5248 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5249 which must appear in the following order:
5250
5251 @itemize
5252 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5253 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5254 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5255 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x)
5256 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5257 LPC43x[2357])
5258 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5259 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5260 LPC1300 and LPC1700
5261 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5262 at which the core is running
5263 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5264 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5265 @quotation Note
5266 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5267 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5268 However, if you do provide it,
5269 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5270 @end quotation
5271 @end itemize
5272
5273 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5274
5275 @example
5276 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5277 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5278 @end example
5279
5280 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5281 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5282 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5283 @end deffn
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5287 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5288 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5289 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5290 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5291 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5292
5293 @example
5294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5295 @end example
5296 @end deffn
5297
5298 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5299 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5300 from NXP.
5301
5302 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5303 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5304 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5305 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5306 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5307 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5308 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5309 you start the PLL.
5310
5311 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5312
5313 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5314 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5315 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5316
5317 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5318 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5319 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5320 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5321 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5322 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5323 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5324
5325 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5326 @example
5327 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5328 @end example
5329
5330 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5331 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5332 @code{flash banks} command.
5333
5334 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5335 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5336 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5337 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5338 a known signature.
5339 Example:
5340 @example
5341 lpc2900 signature 0
5342 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5343 @end example
5344 @end deffn
5345
5346 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5347 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5348 saves it to a file in binary format.
5349 Example:
5350 @example
5351 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5352 @end example
5353 @end deffn
5354
5355 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5356 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5357 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5358 command:
5359
5360 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5361 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5362 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5363 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5364
5365 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5366 Example:
5367 @example
5368 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5369 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5370 @end example
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5374 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5375 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5376 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5377 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5378 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5379 912 bytes.
5380 @quotation Attention
5381 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5382 @end quotation
5383 Example:
5384 @example
5385 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5386 @end example
5387 @end deffn
5388
5389 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5390 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5391 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5392 after the next power cycle.
5393 @quotation Attention
5394 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5395 @end quotation
5396 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5397 Example:
5398 @example
5399 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5400 flash info 0
5401 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5402 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5403 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5404 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5405 @end example
5406 @end deffn
5407
5408 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5409 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5410 effective after the next power cycle.
5411 @quotation Attention
5412 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5413 @end quotation
5414 Examples:
5415 @example
5416 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5417 @end example
5418 @end deffn
5419 @end deffn
5420
5421 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5422 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5423 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5424
5425 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5426 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5427 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5428 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5429
5430 @example
5431 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5432 @end example
5433 @end deffn
5434
5435 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5436 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5437 and integrate flash memory.
5438
5439 @example
5440 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5441 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5442 @end example
5443
5444 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5445 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5446 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5447 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5448 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5449 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5450 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5451 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5452 @end deffn
5453 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5454 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5455 This will remove any Code Protection.
5456 @end deffn
5457 @end deffn
5458
5459 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5460 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5461 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5462 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5463 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5464
5465 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5466 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5467
5468 @example
5469 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5470 @end example
5471
5472 psoc4-specific commands
5473 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5474 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5475
5476 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5477 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5478
5479 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5480 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5481 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5482
5483 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5484 @end deffn
5485
5486 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5487 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5488
5489 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5490 @end deffn
5491 @end deffn
5492
5493 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5494 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx microcontroller family from
5495 Texas Instruments
5496 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5497 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5498 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5499 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5500 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5501 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5502
5503 @example
5504 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5505 @end example
5506
5507 @deffn Command {stellaris recover bank_id}
5508 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to
5509 restore the flash specified by @var{bank_id} and its associated
5510 nonvolatile registers to their factory default values (erased).
5511 This is the only way to remove flash protection or re-enable
5512 debugging if that capability has been disabled.
5513
5514 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5515 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5516 @quotation Warning
5517 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5518 applied to all of them.
5519 @end quotation
5520 @end deffn
5521 @end deffn
5522
5523 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5524 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5525 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5526 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5527 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5528
5529 @example
5530 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5531 @end example
5532
5533 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5534 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5535 the flash driver.
5536
5537 @example
5538 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5539 @end example
5540
5541 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5542 as per the following example.
5543 @example
5544 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5545 @end example
5546
5547 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5548 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5549 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5550 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5551 are defined:
5552
5553 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5554 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5555 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5556 @end deffn
5557
5558 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5559 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5560 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5561 @end deffn
5562
5563 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5564 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5565 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5566 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5570 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5571 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5572 @end deffn
5573 @end deffn
5574
5575 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5576 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5577 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5578 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5579 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5580
5581 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5582 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5583 the flash driver.
5584
5585 @example
5586 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5587 @end example
5588
5589 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5590
5591 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5592 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5593 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5597 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5598 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5599 @end deffn
5600 @end deffn
5601
5602 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5603 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5604 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5605 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5606 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5607
5608 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5609 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5610 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5611 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5612 second bank.
5613
5614 @example
5615 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5616 @end example
5617
5618 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5619
5620 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5621 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5622 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5623 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5624 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5625 @end deffn
5626 @end deffn
5627
5628 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5629 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5630 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5631 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5632 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5633
5634 @example
5635 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5636 @end example
5637
5638 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5639 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5640 for the specified flash bank.
5641 @end deffn
5642 @end deffn
5643
5644 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5645 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5646 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5647 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5648 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5649
5650 @example
5651 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5652 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5653 @end example
5654
5655 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5656 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5657 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5658
5659 @itemize @bullet
5660 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5661 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5662 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5663 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5664 @end itemize
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 @end deffn
5668
5669 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5670 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5671 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5672 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5673
5674 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5675
5676 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5677 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5681 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5682 @end deffn
5683
5684 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5685 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5686 the flash clock.
5687 @end deffn
5688 @end deffn
5689
5690 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5691 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5692 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5693
5694 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5695
5696 @itemize
5697 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5698 @end itemize
5699
5700 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5701 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
5702 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
5703 @example
5704 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5705 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5706 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5707 @end example
5708 @end deffn
5709
5710 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5711 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5712 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5713 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5714 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5715 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5716 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5717
5718 @example
5719 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5720 @end example
5721 @end deffn
5722
5723 @subsection str9xpec driver
5724 @cindex str9xpec
5725
5726 Here is some background info to help
5727 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5728 the str9:
5729 @enumerate
5730 @item
5731 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5732 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5733 @item
5734 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5735 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5736 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5737 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5738 @end enumerate
5739
5740 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5741 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5742 configured for flash bank 0.
5743 @example
5744 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5745 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5746 jtag_reset 0 1
5747 # turn off target polling
5748 poll off
5749 # disable str9 core
5750 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5751 # read option bytes
5752 str9xpec options_read 0
5753 # re-enable str9 core
5754 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5755 poll on
5756 reset halt
5757 @end example
5758 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5759 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5760 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5761 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5762
5763 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5764 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5765 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5766 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5767 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5768
5769 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5770
5771 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5772 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5773 @end deffn
5774
5775 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5776 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5777 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5778 @end deffn
5779
5780 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5781 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5782 erase the device.
5783 @end deffn
5784
5785 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5786 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5787 @end deffn
5788
5789 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5790 Configure str9 boot bank.
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5794 Configure str9 lvd source.
5795 @end deffn
5796
5797 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5798 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5799 @end deffn
5800
5801 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5802 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5803 @end deffn
5804
5805 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5806 Read str9 option bytes.
5807 @end deffn
5808
5809 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5810 Write str9 option bytes.
5811 @end deffn
5812
5813 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5814 unlock str9 device.
5815 @end deffn
5816
5817 @end deffn
5818
5819 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5820 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5821 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5822
5823 @example
5824 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5825 @end example
5826
5827 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5828
5829 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5830 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5831 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5832 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5833 code.
5834 @end deffn
5835 @end deffn
5836
5837 @section mFlash
5838
5839 @subsection mFlash Configuration
5840 @cindex mFlash Configuration
5841
5842 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
5843 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
5844 address @var{base}.
5845 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
5846 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
5847
5848 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
5849
5850 @example
5851 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
5852 @end example
5853
5854 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
5855
5856 @example
5857 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
5858 @end example
5859 @end deffn
5860
5861 @subsection mFlash commands
5862 @cindex mFlash commands
5863
5864 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
5865 Configure mflash PLL.
5866 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
5867 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
5868 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
5869 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
5870 @end deffn
5871
5872 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
5873 Configure bootable option.
5874 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
5875 (4kB) for boot.
5876 @end deffn
5877
5878 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
5879 Configure storage information.
5880 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
5881 written.
5882 @end deffn
5883
5884 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
5885 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
5886 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
5887 @end deffn
5888
5889 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
5890 Probe mflash.
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
5894 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
5895 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
5896 @end deffn
5897
5898 @node Flash Programming
5899 @chapter Flash Programming
5900
5901 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
5902 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5903 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5904
5905 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
5906 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and shutdown.
5907
5908 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
5909 @enumerate
5910 @item 'init' is executed.
5911 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
5912 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
5913 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
5914 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
5915 @item OpenOCD is shutdown.
5916 @end enumerate
5917
5918 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
5919
5920 @example
5921 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
5922 # are optional parameters
5923 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5924 -c "program filename.elf verify reset"
5925
5926 # binary files need the flash address passing
5927 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5928 -c "program filename.bin 0x08000000"
5929 @end example
5930
5931 @node NAND Flash Commands
5932 @chapter NAND Flash Commands
5933 @cindex NAND
5934
5935 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5936 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5937 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5938
5939 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5940 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5941 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5942 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5943 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5944 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5945
5946 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5947 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5948 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5949 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5950 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5951 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5952 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5953 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5954 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5955 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5956
5957 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5958 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5959 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5960 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5961 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5962 every 512 bytes of data.
5963
5964 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5965 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5966 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5967 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5968 ECC mode is used.
5969
5970 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5971 @enumerate
5972 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5973 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5974 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5975 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5976 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5977 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5978 to access that device.
5979 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5980 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5981 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5982 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5983 de-brick a board.
5984 @end enumerate
5985
5986 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5987 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5988 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5989 are only 32 bits wide.
5990 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5991 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5992 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5993 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5994
5995 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5996 @section NAND Configuration Commands
5997 @cindex NAND configuration
5998
5999 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6000 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6001 OpenOCD has initialized.
6002
6003 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6004 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6005 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6006 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6007 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6008 they were a single (larger) device.
6009 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6010 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6011
6012 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6013 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6014 configuration files, not interactively.
6015
6016 @itemize @bullet
6017 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6018 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6019 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6020 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6021 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6022 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6023 commands to the NAND controller.
6024 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6025 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6026 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6027 for more information.
6028 @end itemize
6029 @end deffn
6030
6031 @deffn Command {nand list}
6032 Prints a summary of each device declared
6033 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6034 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6035 @example
6036 > nand list
6037 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6038 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6039 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6040 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6041 >
6042 @end example
6043 @end deffn
6044
6045 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6046 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6047 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6048 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6049 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6050 it with most other NAND commands.
6051 @end deffn
6052
6053 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6054
6055 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6056 @cindex NAND reading
6057 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6058 starting at the specified offset.
6059 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6060
6061 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6062 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6063
6064 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6065 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6066 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6067
6068 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6069 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6070 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6071 method which handled that error correction.
6072
6073 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6074 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6075 @itemize @bullet
6076 @item no oob_* parameter
6077 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6078 @item @code{oob_raw}
6079 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6080 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6081 spare areas associated with each data page.
6082 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6083 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6084 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6085 @item @code{oob_only}
6086 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6087 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6088 spare areas associated with each data page.
6089 @end itemize
6090 @end deffn
6091
6092 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6093 @cindex NAND erasing
6094 @cindex NAND programming
6095 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6096 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6097 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6098 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6099 If those parameters are not specified,
6100 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6101 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6102
6103 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6104 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6105 block marker.
6106 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6107 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6108 @end deffn
6109
6110 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6111 @cindex NAND writing
6112 @cindex NAND programming
6113 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6114 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6115 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6116 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6117
6118 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6119 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6120
6121 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6122 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6123 past the end of the device.
6124 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6125 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6126 if that's being written.)
6127
6128 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6129 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6130 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6131
6132 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6133 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6134 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6135 @itemize @bullet
6136 @item no oob_* parameter
6137 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6138 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6139 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6140 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6141 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6142 @item @code{oob_only}
6143 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6144 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6145 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6146 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6147 @item @code{oob_raw}
6148 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6149 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6150 un-altered OOB.
6151 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6152 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6153 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6154 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6155 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6156 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6157 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6158 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6159 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6160 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6161 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6162 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6163 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6164 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6165 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6166 @end itemize
6167 @end deffn
6168
6169 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6170 @cindex NAND verification
6171 @cindex NAND programming
6172 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6173 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6174 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6175
6176 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6177 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6178
6179 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6180 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6181 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6182 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6183 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6184
6185 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6186 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6187 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6188
6189 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6190 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6191 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6192 be removed in a future release.
6193 @end deffn
6194
6195 @section Other NAND commands
6196 @cindex NAND other commands
6197
6198 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6199 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6200 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6201 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6202 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6203 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6204 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6205 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6206
6207 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6208 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6209 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6213 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6214 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6215 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6216 status for each block.
6217 @end deffn
6218
6219 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6220 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6221 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6222
6223 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6224 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6225 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6226 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6227 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6228
6229 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6230 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6231 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6232 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6233 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6234 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6235 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6236 @end deffn
6237
6238 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6239 @section NAND Driver List
6240 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6241 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6242 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6243
6244 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6245 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6246 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6247 address of the ECC controller.
6248 @example
6249 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6250 @end example
6251 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6252 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6253 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6254 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6255 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6256 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6257 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6258 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6259 @end deffn
6260 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6261 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6262 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6263 @end deffn
6264
6265 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6266 properly configured for input or output.
6267 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6268 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6269 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6270 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6271 @end deffn
6272 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6273 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6274 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6275 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6276 @end deffn
6277 @end deffn
6278
6279 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6280 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6281 chips from Texas Instruments.
6282 It takes three extra parameters:
6283 address of the NAND chip;
6284 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6285 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6286 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6287 @example
6288 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6289 @end example
6290 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6291 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6292 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6293 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6294 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6295 @end deffn
6296
6297 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6298 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6299 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6300 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6301 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6302 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6303 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6304 @end deffn
6305
6306 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6307 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6308 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6309 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6310 @end deffn
6311 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6312
6313 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6314 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6315 should work for this chip aswell.
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6319 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6320 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6321 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6322 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6323 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6324 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6325 @example
6326 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6327 @end example
6328 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6329 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6330 without parameter query status.
6331 @end deffn
6332 @end deffn
6333
6334 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6335 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6336 parameter: the address of the controller.
6337 @example
6338 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6339 @end example
6340 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6341 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6342 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6343 change any behavior.
6344 @end deffn
6345
6346 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6347 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6348 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6349 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6350 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6351 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6352 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6353 specialized commands.
6354 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6355 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6356 change any behavior.
6357 @end deffn
6358
6359 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6360 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6361 @cindex PLD
6362 @cindex FPGA
6363
6364 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6365 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6366 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6367 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6368 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6369 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6370 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6371
6372 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6373
6374 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6375 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6376 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6377
6378 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6379 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6380
6381 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6382 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6383 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6384 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6385 behavior.
6386 @end deffn
6387
6388 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6389 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6390 @end deffn
6391
6392 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6393 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6394 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6398
6399 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6400 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6401 that particular type of PLD.
6402
6403 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2
6404 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6405 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6406 No driver-specific PLD definition options are used,
6407 and one driver-specific command is defined.
6408
6409 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6410 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6411 for FPGA @var{num}.
6412 @end deffn
6413 @end deffn
6414
6415 @node General Commands
6416 @chapter General Commands
6417 @cindex commands
6418
6419 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6420 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6421 commands are documented elsewhere.
6422
6423 Intent:
6424 @itemize @bullet
6425 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6426 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6427 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6428 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6429
6430 @item @b{From the human}
6431 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6432 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6433
6434 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6435 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6436 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6437
6438 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6439 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6440 port is 5555.
6441 @end itemize
6442
6443
6444 @section Daemon Commands
6445
6446 @deffn {Command} exit
6447 Exits the current telnet session.
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6451 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6452 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6453 Not every command provides helptext.
6454
6455 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6456 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6457 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6458 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6459 @end deffn
6460
6461 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6462 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6463 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6464 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6465 Useful in connection with script files
6466 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @deffn Command shutdown
6470 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet, other).
6471 @end deffn
6472
6473 @anchor{debuglevel}
6474 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6475 @cindex message level
6476 Display debug level.
6477 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6478 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6479 Level 0 is error messages only;
6480 level 1 adds warnings;
6481 level 2 adds informational messages;
6482 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6483 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6484 the command line along with the location of that log
6485 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6486 @xref{Running}.
6487 @end deffn
6488
6489 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6490 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6491 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6492 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6493 @example
6494 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6495 @end example
6496 @end deffn
6497
6498 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6499 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6500 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6501 @end deffn
6502
6503 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6504 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6505 @end deffn
6506
6507 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6508 @section Target State handling
6509 @cindex reset
6510 @cindex halt
6511 @cindex target initialization
6512
6513 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6514 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6515 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6516 a current target which is used to perform the
6517 various operations. The current target may be changed
6518 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6519 target which should become current.
6520
6521 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6522 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6523 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6524 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6525 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6526
6527 @emph{With no arguments}:
6528 list all available registers for the current target,
6529 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6530 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6531 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6532 are flagged as such.
6533
6534 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6535 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6536 bypassing any internal cache.
6537
6538 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6539 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6540 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6541 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6542 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6543 relevant module will flush such values.
6544
6545 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6546 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6547
6548 @example
6549 > reg
6550 ===== ARM registers
6551 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6552 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6553 (2) r2 (/32)
6554 ...
6555 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6556 >
6557 @end example
6558 @end deffn
6559
6560 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6561 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6562 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6563 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6564 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6565 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6566 (and enter debug mode).
6567 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6568
6569 @quotation Warning
6570 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6571 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6572 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6573 power mode by gating the core clock;
6574 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6575
6576 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6577 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6578 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6579 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6580 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6581 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6582
6583 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6584 work with a JTAG debugger.
6585 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6586 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6587 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6588 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6589 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6590 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6591 @end quotation
6592
6593 @end deffn
6594
6595 @deffn Command resume [address]
6596 Resume the target at its current code position,
6597 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6598 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6599 @end deffn
6600
6601 @deffn Command step [address]
6602 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6603 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @anchor{resetcommand}
6607 @deffn Command reset
6608 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6609 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6610 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6611 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6612 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6613 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6614
6615 The optional parameter specifies what should
6616 happen after the reset.
6617 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6618 The other options will not work on all systems.
6619 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6620
6621 @itemize @minus
6622 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6623 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6624 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6625 @end itemize
6626 @end deffn
6627
6628 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6629 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6630 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6631 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6632 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6633 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6634 state.
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @section I/O Utilities
6638
6639 These commands are available when
6640 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6641 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6642 notably the ZY1000.
6643 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6644
6645 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6646
6647 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6648 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6649 the text file @file{filename}.
6650 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6651 The last string is followed by a newline.
6652 @end deffn
6653
6654 @deffn Command cat filename
6655 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6656 @end deffn
6657
6658 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6659 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6660 into @file{dest_filename}.
6661 @end deffn
6662
6663 @deffn Command ip
6664 @emph{No description provided.}
6665 @end deffn
6666
6667 @deffn Command ls
6668 @emph{No description provided.}
6669 @end deffn
6670
6671 @deffn Command mac
6672 @emph{No description provided.}
6673 @end deffn
6674
6675 @deffn Command meminfo
6676 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6677 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6678 @end deffn
6679
6680 @deffn Command peek
6681 @emph{No description provided.}
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn Command poke
6685 @emph{No description provided.}
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn Command rm filename
6689 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6690 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn Command trunc filename
6694 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6698 @section Memory access commands
6699 @cindex memory access
6700
6701 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6702 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6703 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6704 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6705
6706 @enumerate
6707 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6708 to change the current target.
6709 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6710 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6711 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6712 @end enumerate
6713
6714 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6715 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6716 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6717 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6718 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6719 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6720 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6721 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6722 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6723 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6724 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6725 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6726 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6727 @end deffn
6728
6729 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6730 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6731 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6732 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6733 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6734 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6735 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6736 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6737 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6738 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @anchor{imageaccess}
6742 @section Image loading commands
6743 @cindex image loading
6744 @cindex image dumping
6745
6746 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6747 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6748 binary file named @var{filename}.
6749 @end deffn
6750
6751 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6752 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6753 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6754 @end deffn
6755
6756 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6757 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6758 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6759 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6760 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6761 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6762 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6763 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6764 separately.
6765 @end deffn
6766
6767 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6768 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6769 The file format may optionally be specified
6770 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6771 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6772 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6773 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6774 @example
6775 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6776 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6777 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6778 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin $address $length
6779 @}
6780 @end example
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6784 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6785 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6786 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6787 The file format may optionally be specified
6788 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6792 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6793 The file format may optionally be specified
6794 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6795 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6796 @end deffn
6797
6798
6799 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6800 @cindex breakpoint
6801 @cindex watchpoint
6802
6803 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6804 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6805 watchpoints.
6806 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6807
6808 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6809 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6810 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6811 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6812 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6813 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6814
6815 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6816 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6820 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6821 @end deffn
6822
6823 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6824 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6828 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6829 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6830 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6831 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6832 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6833 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6834 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6835 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @section Misc Commands
6839
6840 @cindex profiling
6841 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6842 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6843 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6844 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6845 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6846 limit the address range.
6847 @end deffn
6848
6849 @deffn Command {version}
6850 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6854 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6855 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6859 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6860 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6861 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6862
6863 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6864 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6865 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6866 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6867
6868 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6869 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6870 @cindex tracing
6871 @cindex ETM
6872 @cindex ETB
6873
6874 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6875 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6876 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6877
6878 @itemize
6879 @item
6880 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6881 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6882 supports such an interface.
6883 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6884 and trace port support.)
6885 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6886 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6887 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6888 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6889 in the board-specific configuration file.
6890 @item
6891 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6892 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6893 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6894 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6895 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6896 @end itemize
6897
6898 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6899
6900 @quotation Issues
6901 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6902 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6903
6904 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6905 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6906 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6907 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6908 dummy trace port driver}.
6909
6910 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6911 as well as tracing only during specific states
6912 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6913
6914 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6915 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6916 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6917 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6918 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6919
6920 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6921 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6922 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6923 this original style of JTAG access.
6924 @end quotation
6925
6926 @subsection ETM Configuration
6927 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6928
6929 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6930 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6931 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6932
6933 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6934 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6935 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6936 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6937 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6938 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6939 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6940 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6941 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6942
6943 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6944 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6945 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6946
6947 @quotation Warning
6948 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6949 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6950 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6951 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6952 @end quotation
6953
6954 @quotation Note
6955 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6956 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6957 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6958 what CPU activities are traced.
6959 @end quotation
6960 @end deffn
6961
6962 @deffn Command {etm info}
6963 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6964 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6965 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6966 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6967 @end deffn
6968
6969 @deffn Command {etm status}
6970 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6971 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6972 Did trace data overflow?
6973 Was it triggered?
6974 @end deffn
6975
6976 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6977 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6978 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6979 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6980 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6981
6982 @itemize
6983 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6984 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6985 The value is one of
6986 @option{none} (save nothing),
6987 @option{data} (save data),
6988 @option{address} (save addresses),
6989 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6990 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6991 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6992 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6993 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6994 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6995 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6996 trace stream without an image of the code.
6997 @end itemize
6998 @end deffn
6999
7000 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7001 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7002 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7003 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7004 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7005
7006 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7007 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7008 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7012
7013 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7014 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7015 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7016
7017 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7018 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7019 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7020 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7021 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7022 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7023 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7024
7025 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7026
7027 @itemize
7028 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7029 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7030 for instruction access within that function's body.
7031 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7032 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7033 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7034 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7035 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7036 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7037 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7038 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7039 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7040 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7041 @item @emph{... more}
7042 @end itemize
7043
7044 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7045 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7046
7047 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7048 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7049 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7050 @end deffn
7051
7052 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7053 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7057 Opens an image file.
7058 @end deffn
7059
7060 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7061 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7062 @end deffn
7063
7064 @deffn Command {etm start}
7065 Starts trace data collection.
7066 @end deffn
7067
7068 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7069 Stops trace data collection.
7070 @end deffn
7071
7072 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7073 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7074
7075 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7076
7077 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7078 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7079 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7080 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7081 any trace data collection.}
7082 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7083 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7084 @end deffn
7085 @end deffn
7086
7087 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7088 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7089 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7090 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7091 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7092 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7093 @end deffn
7094 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7095 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7096 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7097 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7098 trace trigger becomes active.
7099
7100 @itemize
7101 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7102 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7103 afterwards.
7104 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7105 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7106 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7107 what caused that event to happen.
7108 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7109 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7110 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7111 how the event caused trouble.
7112 @end itemize
7113 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7114 @end deffn
7115
7116 @end deffn
7117
7118 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7119 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7120 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7121 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7122 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7123
7124 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7125 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7126
7127 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7128 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7129 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7133 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7137 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7138 @end deffn
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141
7142 @section Generic ARM
7143 @cindex ARM
7144
7145 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7146 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7147 commands that may be available.
7148
7149 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7150 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7151 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7152 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7153 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7154 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7155 @end deffn
7156
7157 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7158 @cindex disassemble
7159 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7160 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7161 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7162 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7163 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7164 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7165 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7166
7167 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7168 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7169 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7170 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7171 with a handful of exceptions.
7172 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7173 @end deffn
7174
7175 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7176 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7177 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7178 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7179 and using the MCR instruction.
7180 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7181 an ARM register.)
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7185 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7186 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7187 and the MRC instruction.
7188 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7189 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7190 an ARM register.)
7191 @end deffn
7192
7193 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7194 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7195 core mode if necessary.
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7199 @cindex ARM semihosting
7200 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7201
7202 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7203 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7204 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7205 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7206 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7207 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7208 @end deffn
7209
7210 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7211 @cindex ARMv4
7212 @cindex ARMv5
7213
7214 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7215 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7216 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7217 variant.
7218
7219 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7220 @cindex ARM7
7221 @cindex ARM9
7222
7223 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7224 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7225 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7226 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7227
7228 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7229 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7230 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7231 instead of breakpoints.
7232 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7233
7234 This should be
7235 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7236 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7237 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7238 @end deffn
7239
7240 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7241 @cindex DCC
7242 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7243 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7244 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7245
7246 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7247 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7248 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7252 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7253 that don't check completion of the operation.
7254 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7255
7256 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7257 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7258 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7259 @end deffn
7260
7261 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7262 @cindex ARM720T
7263
7264 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7265 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7266 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7267 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7268
7269 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7270 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7271 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7272
7273 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7274 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7275 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7276 @end deffn
7277
7278 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7279 @cindex ARM9
7280
7281 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7282 integer processors.
7283 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7284
7285 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7286 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7287 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7288 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7289
7290 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7291 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7292 @cindex vector_catch
7293 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7294 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7295 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7296 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7297 to those hardware vectors.
7298
7299 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7300 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7301 vector catch hardware to intercept
7302 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7303 @option{none} of them,
7304 or a list with one or more of the following:
7305 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7306 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7307 @end deffn
7308
7309 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7310 @cindex ARM920T
7311
7312 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7313 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7314 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7315 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7316 and ARM9 commands.
7317
7318 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7319 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7320 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7321 @end deffn
7322
7323 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7324 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7325 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7326 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7327 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7328 (Not all registers can be written.)
7329 @end deffn
7330
7331 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7332 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7333 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7334
7335 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7336 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7337 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7338 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7339 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7340 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7341 @end deffn
7342
7343 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7344 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7348 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7349 @end deffn
7350
7351 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7352 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7353
7354 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7355 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7356 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7357 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7358 and ARM9 commands.
7359
7360 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7361 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7362
7363 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7364 Print information about the caches found.
7365 @end deffn
7366
7367 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7368 @cindex ARM966E
7369
7370 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7371 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7372 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7373 and ARM9 commands.
7374
7375 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7376 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7377 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7378 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7379 ARM966E-S TRM.
7380 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7381 as required for BIST support.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @subsection XScale specific commands
7385 @cindex XScale
7386
7387 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7388
7389 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7390 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7391 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7392 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7393 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7394 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7395 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7396
7397 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7398 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7399 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7400 the mini-IC.
7401
7402 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7403 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7404 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7405 code layout in memory:
7406 @example
7407 _vectors:
7408 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7409 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7410 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7411 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7412 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7413 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7414 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7415 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7416 .org 0x100
7417 .long real_reset_vector
7418 .long real_ui_handler
7419 .long real_swi_handler
7420 .long real_pf_abort
7421 .long real_data_abort
7422 .long 0 /* unused */
7423 .long real_irq_handler
7424 .long real_fiq_handler
7425 @end example
7426
7427 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7428 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7429 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7430 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7431 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7432 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7433 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7434 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7435 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7436 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7437 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7438 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7439 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7440 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7441 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7442 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7443 software.
7444
7445 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7446 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7447 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7448 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7449
7450 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7451 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7452 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7453 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7454 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7455 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7456 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7457 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7458 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7459
7460 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7461 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7462
7463 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7464 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7465 @end deffn
7466
7467 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7468 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7469 @end deffn
7470
7471 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7472 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7476 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7477 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7481 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7482 @end deffn
7483
7484 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7485 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7486 @end deffn
7487
7488 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7489 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7490 @end deffn
7491
7492 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7493 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7494 @end deffn
7495
7496 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7497 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7498 @end deffn
7499
7500 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7501 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7502 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7503 and modifying how it is emptied.
7504 @end deffn
7505
7506 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7507 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7508 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7509 The image @var{type} may be one of
7510 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7511 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7512 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7513 @end deffn
7514
7515 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7516 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7517 @cindex vector_catch
7518 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7519 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7520
7521 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7522 @example
7523 0x01 Trap Reset
7524 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7525 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7526 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7527 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7528 0x20 reserved
7529 0x40 Trap IRQ
7530 0x80 Trap FIQ
7531 @end example
7532 @end deffn
7533
7534 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7535 @cindex vector_table
7536
7537 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7538 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7539 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7540 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7541 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7542
7543 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7544
7545 @end deffn
7546
7547 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7548 @cindex ARMv6
7549
7550 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7551 @cindex ARM11
7552
7553 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7554 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7555 which is enabled by default.
7556 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7557 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7558 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7559 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7560 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7561 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7562 @end deffn
7563
7564 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7565 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7566 which is enabled by default.
7567 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7568 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7569 @end deffn
7570
7571 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7572 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7573 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7574 they are disabled by default.
7575 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7579 @cindex vector_catch
7580 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7581 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7582 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7583
7584 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7585 for certain hardware events.
7586 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7587 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7588 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7592 @cindex ARMv7
7593
7594 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7595 @cindex Debug Access Port
7596 @cindex DAP
7597 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7598 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7599 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7600
7601 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7602 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7603 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7607 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7611 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7612 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7616 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7617 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7621 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7622 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7623 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7624 @end deffn
7625
7626 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7627 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7628 Defaulting to 0.
7629 @end deffn
7630
7631 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7632 @cindex Cortex-M
7633
7634 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7635 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7636
7637 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7638 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7639 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7640 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7641 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7642 the step command leaves with the core running.
7643
7644 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7645 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7646 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7647
7648 Default is @option{auto}.
7649 @end deffn
7650
7651 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7652 @cindex vector_catch
7653 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7654 for certain hardware events.
7655
7656 Parameters request interception of
7657 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7658 @option{none} of them,
7659 or one or more of the following:
7660 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7661 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7662 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7663 @option{irq_err},
7664 @option{state_err},
7665 @option{chk_err}, or
7666 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7667 @option{reset}.
7668 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7669 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7670 are mapped to HardFault.
7671 UsageFault checks for
7672 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7673 must also be explicitly enabled.
7674
7675 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7679 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7680 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7681 @itemize @minus
7682 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7683 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7684 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7685 @end itemize
7686 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7687 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7688 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7689 the peripherals.
7690 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7691 @end deffn
7692
7693 @section Intel Architecture
7694
7695 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7696 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7697 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7698 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7699 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7700 @itemize
7701 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7702 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7703 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7704 @end itemize
7705
7706 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7707 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7708 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7709
7710 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7711 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7712 @end deffn
7713
7714 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7715 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7716 @end deffn
7717
7718 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7719 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7720 @end deffn
7721
7722 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7723 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7724 @end deffn
7725
7726 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7727 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7728 @end deffn
7729
7730 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7731 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7735
7736 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7737 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7738
7739 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7740 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7741 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7742 @end deffn
7743 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7744 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7745
7746 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7747
7748 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7749 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7750 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7751 @end deffn
7752
7753 @subsection Registers commands
7754 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7755 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7756 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7757
7758 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7759
7760 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7761 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7762 and "timer" groups.
7763
7764 @emph{example:}
7765 @example
7766 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7767 @end example
7768
7769
7770 @end deffn
7771 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7772 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7773
7774 @emph{group} can be "system",
7775 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7776 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7780 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7781 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7782 @cindex tracing
7783 @cindex libdcc
7784 @cindex DCC
7785 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7786 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7787 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7788 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7789
7790 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7791 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7792 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7793 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7794 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7795 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7796
7797 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7798 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7799 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7800 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7801 The target being debugged may
7802 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7803 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7804 each supported by a command:
7805
7806 @itemize
7807 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7808 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7809 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7810 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7811
7812 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7813 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7814 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7815
7816 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7817 and then displayed at any time.
7818 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7819
7820 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7821 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7822 @end itemize
7823
7824 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7825 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7826 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7827 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7828 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7829 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7830 does the same thing.
7831
7832 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7833 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7834 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7835 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7836 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7837
7838 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7839 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7840 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7841 @end deffn
7842
7843 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7844 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7845 in the order they triggered.
7846 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7847 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7848 history records.
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7852 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7853 they have been triggered.
7854 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7855 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7856 and associates it with that identifier.
7857
7858 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7859 are not related except by this command.
7860 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7861 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7862 @end deffn
7863
7864
7865 @node JTAG Commands
7866 @chapter JTAG Commands
7867 @cindex JTAG Commands
7868 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7869 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7870 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7871 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7872 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7873
7874 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7875 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7876
7877 @itemize @bullet
7878 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7879 devices such as a CPUs.
7880 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7881 standard state machine (in parallel)
7882 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7883 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7884 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7885 while the reading previous ones.
7886 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7887 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7888 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7889 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7890 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7891 registers.
7892 @end itemize
7893
7894 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7895
7896 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7897 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7898 the order of TAP state transitions.
7899 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7900 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7901 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7902 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7903 these commands are not available.
7904
7905 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7906 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7907 that specify the entire register.
7908 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7909 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7910 The return value holds the original value of each
7911 of those fields.
7912
7913 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7914 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7915 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7916 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7917 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7918
7919 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7920 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7921
7922 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7923 in that state.
7924 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7925 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7926 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7927
7928 @quotation Warning
7929 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7930 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7931 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7932 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7933 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7934 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7935 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7936 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7937 @end quotation
7938 @end deffn
7939
7940 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7941 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7942 This may be used for performance tuning.
7943
7944 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7945 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7946 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7947 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7948 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7949 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7953 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7954 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7955 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7956 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7957 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7958
7959 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7960 in that state.
7961 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7962 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7963 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7964
7965 @quotation Note
7966 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7967 register values, unlike data register values.
7968 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
7969 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
7970 @end quotation
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
7974 Set values of reset signals.
7975 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
7976 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
7977 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
7978 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7979 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
7980 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7981 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7982
7983 Note that TRST is specially handled.
7984 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7985 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7986 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7987 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7988 instead of the TRST signal.
7989 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7990 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7991 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7992 with handlers for that event.
7993 @end deffn
7994
7995 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
7996 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
7997 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
7998 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
7999 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8000 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8001 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8002 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8003 The final state must also be stable.
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8007 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8008 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8009 Instructions often need some time
8010 to execute before they take effect.
8011 @end deffn
8012
8013 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8014 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8015
8016 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8017 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8018 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8019 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8020 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8021 @end deffn
8022
8023 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8024 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8025 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8026 must also be enabled.
8027 Default is enabled.
8028 @end deffn
8029
8030 @section TAP state names
8031 @cindex TAP state names
8032
8033 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8034 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8035 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8036 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8037
8038 @itemize @bullet
8039 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8040 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8041 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8042 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8043 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8044 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8045 through the data register
8046 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8047 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8048 for update or more shifting
8049 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8050 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8051 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8052 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8053 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8054 through the instruction register
8055 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8056 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8057 for update or more shifting
8058 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8059 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8060 @end itemize
8061
8062 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8063 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8064 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8065 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8066
8067 @itemize @bullet
8068 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8069 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8070 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8071 may not be as expected.
8072 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8073 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8074 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8075 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8076 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8077 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8078 @end itemize
8079
8080 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8081 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8082
8083 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8084 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8085 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8086 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8087
8088 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8089 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8090 @cindex SVF
8091
8092 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8093 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8094 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8095 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8096
8097 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8098 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8099 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8100 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8101 each command is logged before it is executed.
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8105 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8106 @cindex XSVF
8107
8108 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8109 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8110 Xilinx devices.
8111 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8112 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8113
8114 @quotation Important
8115 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8116 @end quotation
8117
8118 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8119 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8120 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8121 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8122 that TAP.
8123 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8124 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8125 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8126 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8127 @end deffn
8128
8129 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8130 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8131 after building the software.
8132 You may find them useful:
8133
8134 @itemize
8135 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8136 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8137 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8138 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8139 @end itemize
8140
8141 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8142 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8143 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8144 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8145 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8146 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8147 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8148
8149
8150 @node Utility Commands
8151 @chapter Utility Commands
8152 @cindex Utility Commands
8153
8154 @section RAM testing
8155 @cindex RAM testing
8156
8157 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8158 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8159 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8160 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8161 hardware problems.
8162
8163 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8164 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8165 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8166 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8167
8168 Load the memory testing functions with
8169
8170 @example
8171 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8172 @end example
8173
8174 to get access to the following facilities:
8175
8176 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8177 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8178 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8179 @end deffn
8180
8181 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8182 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8183 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8184 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8188 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8189 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8190 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8191 @end deffn
8192
8193 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8194 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8195 @end deffn
8196
8197 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8198 @cindex Firmware recovery
8199
8200 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8201 devices recovery with JTAG.
8202
8203 For quickstart instructions run:
8204 @example
8205 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8206 @end example
8207
8208 @node TFTP
8209 @chapter TFTP
8210 @cindex TFTP
8211 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8212 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8213
8214 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8215 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8216 server (tftpd). For example,
8217
8218 @example
8219 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8220 @end example
8221
8222 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8223 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8224
8225 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8226 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8227 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8228 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8229
8230 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8231 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8232 @cindex GDB
8233 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8234 to debug remote targets.
8235 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8236
8237 @itemize
8238 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8239 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8240 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8241 as shown in this chapter.
8242 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8243 that also will probably need to be configured.
8244 @end itemize
8245
8246 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8247 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8248 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8249 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8250 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8251 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8252
8253 @section Connecting to GDB
8254 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8255 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8256 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8257 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8258 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8259
8260 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8261
8262 @enumerate
8263 @item
8264 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8265 @example
8266 target remote localhost:3333
8267 @end example
8268 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8269
8270 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8271 @example
8272 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8273 @end example
8274 @item
8275 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8276 @example
8277 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8278 @end example
8279 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8280 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8281 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8282 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8283 @end enumerate
8284
8285 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8286 GDB command line.
8287
8288 @section Sample GDB session startup
8289
8290 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8291 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8292 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8293 small ARM program.
8294 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8295 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8296
8297 @example
8298 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8299 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8300 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8301 ...
8302 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8303 ...
8304 (gdb) load
8305 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8306 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8307 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8308 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8309 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8310 (gdb) continue
8311 Continuing.
8312 ...
8313 @end example
8314
8315 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8316 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8317 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8318 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8319
8320 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8321
8322 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8323 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8324 packet size and the device's memory map.
8325 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8326 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8327 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8328
8329 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8330 You may need to set those up by hand.
8331 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8332 something like:
8333
8334 @example
8335 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8336 @end example
8337
8338 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8339
8340 @example
8341 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8342 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8343 @end example
8344
8345 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8346 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8347 do not have such restrictions.
8348
8349 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8350 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8351 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8352
8353 @example
8354 define hook-step
8355 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8356 end
8357 define hookpost-step
8358 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8359 end
8360 @end example
8361
8362 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8363 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8364 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8365 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8366
8367 @section Programming using GDB
8368 @cindex Programming using GDB
8369 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8370
8371 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8372 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8373 @example
8374 gdb_memory_map disable
8375 @end example
8376 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8377 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8378 working area.
8379
8380 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8381 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8382 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8383 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8384
8385 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8386 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8387
8388 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8389 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8390 @example
8391 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8392 @end example
8393
8394 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8395 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8396
8397 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8398 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8399 will be used.
8400
8401 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8402 script can be executed:
8403 @example
8404 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8405 @end example
8406
8407 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8408 can be used.
8409 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8410 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8411 @cindex SMP
8412 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8413 @itemize @bullet
8414 @item j - smp status request
8415 @item J - smp set request
8416 @end itemize
8417
8418 OpenOCD implements :
8419 @itemize @bullet
8420 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8421 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8422 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8423 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8424 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8425 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8426 @end itemize
8427
8428 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8429 @itemize @bullet
8430 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8431 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8432 @example
8433 set $_core 1
8434 #Jc01 packet is sent
8435 print $_core
8436 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8437 @end example
8438
8439 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8440 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8441
8442 @example
8443 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8444 define toggle0
8445 maint packet Jc0
8446 continue
8447 main packet Jc-1
8448 end
8449 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8450 define toggle1
8451 maint packet Jc1
8452 continue
8453 main packet Jc-1
8454 end
8455 @end example
8456 @end itemize
8457
8458 @section RTOS Support
8459 @cindex RTOS Support
8460 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8461
8462 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8463 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8464
8465 @* An example setup is below:
8466
8467 @example
8468 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8469 @end example
8470
8471 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8472
8473 Currently supported rtos's include:
8474 @itemize @bullet
8475 @item @option{eCos}
8476 @item @option{ThreadX}
8477 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8478 @item @option{linux}
8479 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8480 @item @option{embKernel}
8481 @end itemize
8482
8483 @quotation Note
8484 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8485 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8486 @end quotation
8487
8488 @table @code
8489 @item eCos symbols
8490 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8491 @item ThreadX symbols
8492 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8493 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8494 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8495 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8496 xTasksWaitingTermination, xSuspendedTaskList, uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8497 @item linux symbols
8498 init_task.
8499 @item ChibiOS symbols
8500 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8501 @item embKernel symbols
8502 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8503 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8504 @end table
8505
8506 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8507 some, eg. FreeRTOS @option{xTasksWaitingTermination} is only exported
8508 if @option{INCLUDE_vTaskDelete} is defined during the build.
8509
8510 @node Tcl Scripting API
8511 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8512 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8513 @cindex Tcl scripts
8514 @section API rules
8515
8516 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8517 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8518 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8519
8520 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8521 pair list and lists.
8522
8523 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8524 list.
8525
8526 @example
8527 > set foo(me) Duane
8528 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8529 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8530 > set foo(duck) Donald
8531 @end example
8532
8533 If one does this:
8534
8535 @example
8536 > set foo
8537 @end example
8538
8539 The result is:
8540
8541 @example
8542 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8543 @end example
8544
8545 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8546
8547 @verbatim
8548 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8549 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8550 }
8551 @end verbatim
8552
8553 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8554 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8555
8556 @section Internal low-level Commands
8557
8558 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8559 invoke directly.
8560
8561 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8562 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8563 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8564
8565 @itemize @bullet
8566 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8567
8568 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8569 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8570
8571 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8572 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8573
8574 Return information about the flash banks
8575
8576 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8577
8578 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8579 its execution. Example:
8580
8581 @example
8582 > capture "reset init"
8583 @end example
8584
8585 @end itemize
8586
8587 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8588 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8589 called "flash_banks".
8590
8591 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8592
8593 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8594 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8595 holds one of the following values:
8596
8597 @itemize @bullet
8598 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8599 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8600 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8601 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8602 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8603 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8604 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8605 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8606 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8607 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8608 @end itemize
8609
8610 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8611
8612 @quotation Note
8613 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8614 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8615 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8616 is jim, not real tcl).
8617 @end quotation
8618
8619 @section Tcl RPC server
8620 @cindex RPC
8621
8622 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8623 commands and receive the results.
8624
8625 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8626 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8627 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8628 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8629 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8630
8631 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8632 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8633 @command{capture} command.
8634
8635 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8636
8637 @node FAQ
8638 @chapter FAQ
8639 @cindex faq
8640 @enumerate
8641 @anchor{faqrtck}
8642 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8643 @cindex RTCK
8644 @cindex adaptive clocking
8645 @*
8646
8647 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8648 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8649 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8650 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8651
8652 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8653 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8654 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8655 @enumerate
8656 @item
8657 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8658 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8659 @item
8660 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8661 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8662 @end enumerate
8663
8664 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8665 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8666 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8667 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8668 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8669 power).
8670
8671 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8672 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8673 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8674 ARM926 scenario).
8675 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8676 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8677 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8678
8679 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8680 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8681 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8682 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8683
8684 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8685
8686 In order to make use of this,
8687 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8688 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8689
8690 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8691 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8692 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8693 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8694 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8695
8696 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8697 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8698 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8699 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8700
8701 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8702 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8703 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8704 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8705 with a CPLD.
8706 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8707 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8708 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8709 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8710 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8711 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8712
8713 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8714
8715 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8716
8717 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8718 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8719 depending on the chips on your board.
8720 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8721 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8722 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8723
8724 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8725 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8726 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8727
8728 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8729 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8730 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8731 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8732
8733 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8734 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8735 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8736 this way.
8737
8738 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8739 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8740 clock rate.
8741 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8742 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8743 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8744
8745 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8746
8747 @example
8748 # Example: 1.234MHz
8749 adapter_khz 1234
8750 @end example
8751
8752
8753 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8754
8755 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8756 around Windows filenames.
8757
8758 @example
8759 > echo \a
8760
8761 > echo @{\a@}
8762 \a
8763 > echo "\a"
8764
8765 >
8766 @end example
8767
8768
8769 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8770
8771 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8772 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8773 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8774
8775 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8776 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8777 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8778
8779 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8780 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8781 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8782
8783 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8784
8785 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8786 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8787 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8788 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8789
8790 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8791 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8792 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8793
8794 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8795 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8796
8797 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8798 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8799 memory read caused data abort".
8800
8801 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8802 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8803 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8804 be done, feel free to add this here.
8805
8806 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8807 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8808 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8809 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8810 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8811 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8812 gracefully stops.
8813
8814 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8815 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8816 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8817
8818 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8819 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8820 bytes. Painful...
8821
8822
8823 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8824 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8825
8826 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8827 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8828 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8829 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8830 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8831 reset, everything else should work fine.
8832
8833 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8834 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8835 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8836 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8837
8838 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8839 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8840 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8841 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8842
8843 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8844
8845 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8846 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8847 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8848 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8849
8850 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8851 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8852 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8853 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8854
8855 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8856 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8857 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8858
8859 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8860 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8861
8862 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8863 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8864 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8865 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8866 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8867 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8868 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8869 clock frequency?
8870
8871 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8872 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8873 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8874 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8875 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8876
8877 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8878
8879 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8880 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8881 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8882 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8883 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8884 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8885 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8886
8887 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8888
8889 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8890 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8891 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8892 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8893
8894 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8895 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8896 particular order?
8897
8898 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8899 the same order used by the hardware.
8900
8901 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8902 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8903 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8904 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8905 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
8906 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
8907
8908 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
8909 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
8910 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
8911 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
8912
8913 @itemize @bullet
8914 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
8915 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
8916 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
8917 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
8918 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
8919 @end itemize
8920
8921 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
8922
8923 @itemize @bullet
8924 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
8925 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
8926 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
8927 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
8928 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
8929 @end itemize
8930
8931
8932 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
8933 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
8934 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
8935
8936 TODO.
8937
8938 @end enumerate
8939
8940 @node Tcl Crash Course
8941 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
8942 @cindex Tcl
8943
8944 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
8945 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
8946 how the Tcl scripts work.
8947
8948 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
8949 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
8950 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
8951 OpenOCD.
8952
8953 @section Tcl Rule #1
8954 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
8955 @enumerate
8956 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
8957 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8958 @end enumerate
8959
8960 The Tcl equal is this:
8961
8962 @enumerate
8963 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
8964 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8965 @end enumerate
8966
8967 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
8968 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
8969
8970 @section Tcl Rule #1b
8971 There is a second pair of rules.
8972 @enumerate
8973 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
8974 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
8975 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
8976 in Tcl.
8977 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8978 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
8979 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
8980 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
8981 @end enumerate
8982
8983 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
8984 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
8985 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
8986 Everything is a string}
8987
8988 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
8989 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
8990 difference is subtle.
8991 @enumerate
8992 @item Parse Time
8993 @item Evaluation Time
8994 @end enumerate
8995
8996 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
8997 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
8998 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
8999
9000 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9001 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9002 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9003 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9004
9005 @itemize @bullet
9006 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9007 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9008 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9009 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9010 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9011 @example
9012 # bash example
9013 X=`date`
9014 echo "The Date is: $X"
9015 # Tcl example
9016 set X [date]
9017 puts "The Date is: $X"
9018 @end example
9019 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9020 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9021 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9022 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9023 is a string}
9024 @example
9025 set x "Dinner"
9026 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9027 @end example
9028 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9029 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9030 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9031 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9032 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9033 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9034 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9035 @end itemize
9036
9037 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9038
9039 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9040
9041 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9042
9043 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9044 the normal way.
9045
9046 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9047 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9048 line is immedatly executed.
9049
9050 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9051 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9052
9053 @subsection Command Execution
9054
9055 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9056 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9057 control flow operators.
9058
9059 Commands are executed like this:
9060
9061 @enumerate
9062 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9063 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9064 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9065 @end enumerate
9066
9067 It sort of works like this:
9068 @example
9069 for(;;)@{
9070 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9071
9072 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9073
9074 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9075 @}
9076 @end example
9077
9078 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9079 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9080 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9081 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9082 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9083 ``LookupCommand()''
9084
9085 @subsection The FOR command
9086
9087 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9088 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9089 command just like any other command.
9090
9091 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9092 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9093 are:
9094
9095 @enumerate 0
9096 @item The ascii text 'for'
9097 @item The start text
9098 @item The test expression
9099 @item The next text
9100 @item The body text
9101 @end enumerate
9102
9103 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9104 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9105 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9106 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9107
9108 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9109 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9110
9111 @example
9112 int
9113 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9114 int *argc,
9115 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9116 @end example
9117
9118 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9119 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9120 still operates in the same basic way.
9121
9122 @subsection FOR command implementation
9123
9124 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9125 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9126
9127 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9128
9129 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9130
9131 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9132 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9133 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9134
9135 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9136 expression and returns a value.
9137
9138 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9139 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9140 @example
9141 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9142
9143 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9144
9145 int
9146 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9147 int argc,
9148 char **argv )
9149 @{
9150 if( argc != 5 )@{
9151 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9152 return ERROR;
9153 @}
9154
9155 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9156
9157 // Execute the start statement.
9158 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9159
9160 // Top of loop test
9161 for(;;)@{
9162 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9163 if( i == 0 )
9164 break;
9165
9166 // Execute the body
9167 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9168
9169 // Execute the LOOP part
9170 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9171 @}
9172
9173 // Return no error
9174 SetResult( interp, "" );
9175 return SUCCESS;
9176 @}
9177 @end example
9178
9179 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9180 in the same basic way.
9181
9182 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9183
9184 @subsection source and find commands
9185 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9186 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9187 @*Remember the parsing rules
9188 @enumerate
9189 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9190 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9191 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9192 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9193 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9194 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9195 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9196 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9197 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9198 @end enumerate
9199 @subsection format command
9200 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9201 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9202 @b{sprintf()}.
9203 @b{Example}
9204 @example
9205 set x 6
9206 set y 7
9207 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9208 @end example
9209 @enumerate
9210 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9211 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9212 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9213 @* Refer to Rule #1
9214 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9215 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9216 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9217 @end enumerate
9218 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9219 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9220 @example
9221 #1 Good
9222 proc someproc @{@} @{
9223 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9224 @}
9225 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9226 #2 Good - no variables
9227 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9228 #3 Good Curly Braces
9229 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9230 puts "Time: [date]"
9231 @}
9232 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9233 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9234 @end example
9235 @enumerate
9236 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9237 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9238 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9239 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9240 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9241 command.
9242 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9243 @*There are 4 examples:
9244 @enumerate
9245 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9246 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9247 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9248 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9249 @end enumerate
9250
9251 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9252 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9253 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9254
9255 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9256 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9257 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9258 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9259 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9260 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9261 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9262 @end enumerate
9263 @subsection Global Variables
9264 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9265 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9266 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9267 @example
9268 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9269 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9270 global x #Global variable X
9271 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9272 @}
9273 @end example
9274 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9275 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9276 @example
9277 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9278 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9279 # Create var name
9280 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9281 # Make it a global
9282 global $vn
9283 # Set it.
9284 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9285 @}
9286 @end example
9287 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9288 @example
9289 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9290 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9291 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9292 @}
9293 @end example
9294
9295 @include fdl.texi
9296
9297 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9298 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9299 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9300 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9301 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9302 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9303
9304 @printindex cp
9305
9306 @node Command and Driver Index
9307 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9308 @printindex fn
9309
9310 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)